]>
Commit | Line | Data |
---|---|---|
b80282d5 | 1 | _dnl__ -*-Texinfo-*- |
9bcc06ef | 2 | _dnl__ Copyright (c) 1988 1989 1990 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
e91b87a3 | 3 | \input texinfo |
5a131cc7 | 4 | @setfilename _GDBP__.info |
8734fc33 | 5 | @c $Id$ |
9c3ad547 | 6 | @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO-2 macros and info-makers to format properly. |
5a131cc7 RP |
7 | @c |
8 | @c NOTE: this manual is marked up for preprocessing with a collection | |
9 | @c of m4 macros called "pretex.m4". If you see <_if__> and <_fi__> | |
10 | @c scattered around the source, you have the full source before | |
11 | @c preprocessing; if you don't, you have the source configured for | |
12 | @c _HOST__ architectures (and you can of course get the full source, | |
13 | @c with all configurations, from wherever you got this). | |
14 | _if__(0) | |
15 | ||
9bcc06ef RP |
16 | THIS IS THE SOURCE PRIOR TO PREPROCESSING. The full source needs to |
17 | be run through m4 before either tex- or info- formatting: for example, | |
08665207 | 18 | _0__ |
3e0d0a27 | 19 | m4 pretex.m4 none.m4 all.m4 gdb.texinfo >gdb-all.texinfo |
08665207 | 20 | _1__ |
70b88761 RP |
21 | will produce (assuming your path finds either GNU m4 >= 0.84, or SysV |
22 | m4; Berkeley won't do) a file suitable for formatting. See the text in | |
23 | "pretex.m4" for a fuller explanation (and the macro definitions). | |
e91b87a3 | 24 | |
9bcc06ef | 25 | _fi__(0) |
3e0d0a27 | 26 | _include__(gdbVN.m4) |
0e0fa7ce RP |
27 | @tex |
28 | \def\$#1${{#1}} % Kluge: collect RCS revision info without $...$ | |
29 | \xdef\manvers{\$Revision$} % For use in headers, footers too | |
0e0fa7ce | 30 | @end tex |
70b88761 RP |
31 | @c |
32 | @syncodeindex ky cp | |
33 | @c FOR UPDATES LEADING TO THIS DRAFT, GDB CHANGELOG CONSULTED BETWEEN: | |
c338a2fd | 34 | @c Fri Sep 20 16:10:52 1991 John Gilmore (gnu at cygnus.com) |
70b88761 RP |
35 | @c Sat Dec 22 02:51:40 1990 John Gilmore (gnu at cygint) |
36 | @ifinfo | |
37 | This file documents the GNU debugger _GDBN__. | |
38 | ||
39 | Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | |
40 | ||
41 | Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of | |
42 | this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice | |
43 | are preserved on all copies. | |
44 | ||
45 | @ignore | |
46 | Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the | |
47 | results, provided the printed document carries copying permission | |
48 | notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph | |
49 | (this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual). | |
50 | ||
51 | @end ignore | |
52 | Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this | |
53 | manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the | |
54 | section entitled ``GNU General Public License'' is included exactly as | |
55 | in the original, and provided that the entire resulting derived work is | |
56 | distributed under the terms of a permission notice identical to this | |
57 | one. | |
58 | ||
59 | Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual | |
60 | into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions, | |
61 | except that the section entitled ``GNU General Public License'' may be | |
62 | included in a translation approved by the Free Software Foundation | |
63 | instead of in the original English. | |
64 | @end ifinfo | |
c2bbbb22 | 65 | @c @smallbook |
70b88761 RP |
66 | @setchapternewpage odd |
67 | _if__(_GENERIC__) | |
3e0d0a27 | 68 | @settitle Using _GDBN__ (<v>_GDB_VN__) |
70b88761 RP |
69 | _fi__(_GENERIC__) |
70 | _if__(!_GENERIC__) | |
3e0d0a27 | 71 | @settitle Using _GDBN__ <v>_GDB_VN__ (_HOST__) |
70b88761 RP |
72 | _fi__(!_GENERIC__) |
73 | @iftex | |
74 | @finalout | |
75 | @end iftex | |
76 | @titlepage | |
77 | @title{Using _GDBN__} | |
78 | @subtitle{A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger} | |
79 | _if__(!_GENERIC__) | |
80 | @subtitle{On _HOST__ Systems} | |
81 | _fi__(!_GENERIC__) | |
82 | @sp 1 | |
83 | @c Maybe crank this up to "Fourth Edition" when released at FSF | |
3e0d0a27 RP |
84 | @c @subtitle Third Edition---_GDBN__ version _GDB_VN__ |
85 | @subtitle _GDBN__ version _GDB_VN__ | |
54e6b3c3 | 86 | @subtitle July 1991 |
70b88761 RP |
87 | @author{Richard M. Stallman@qquad @hfill Free Software Foundation} |
88 | @author{Roland H. Pesch@qquad @hfill Cygnus Support} | |
89 | @page | |
90 | @tex | |
91 | {\parskip=0pt | |
92 | \hfill rms\@ai.mit.edu, pesch\@cygnus.com\par | |
93 | \hfill {\it Using _GDBN__}, \manvers\par | |
94 | \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par | |
95 | } | |
96 | @end tex | |
97 | ||
98 | @vskip 0pt plus 1filll | |
99 | Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | |
100 | ||
101 | Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of | |
102 | this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice | |
103 | are preserved on all copies. | |
104 | ||
105 | Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this | |
106 | manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the | |
107 | section entitled ``GNU General Public License'' is included exactly as | |
108 | in the original, and provided that the entire resulting derived work is | |
109 | distributed under the terms of a permission notice identical to this | |
110 | one. | |
111 | ||
112 | Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual | |
113 | into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions, | |
114 | except that the section entitled ``GNU General Public License'' may be | |
115 | included in a translation approved by the Free Software Foundation | |
116 | instead of in the original English. | |
117 | @end titlepage | |
118 | @page | |
119 | ||
120 | @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir) | |
121 | @ifinfo | |
3e0d0a27 | 122 | This file describes version _GDB_VN__ of GDB, the GNU symbolic debugger. |
70b88761 RP |
123 | @end ifinfo |
124 | ||
125 | @menu | |
b80282d5 | 126 | * Summary:: Summary of _GDBN__ |
3e0d0a27 | 127 | * New Features:: New Features in _GDBN__ version _GDB_VN__ |
b80282d5 RP |
128 | * Sample Session:: A Sample _GDBN__ Session |
129 | * Invocation:: Getting In and Out of _GDBN__ | |
c2bbbb22 | 130 | * Commands:: _GDBN__ Commands |
b80282d5 RP |
131 | * Running:: Running Programs Under _GDBN__ |
132 | * Stopping:: Stopping and Continuing | |
133 | * Stack:: Examining the Stack | |
134 | * Source:: Examining Source Files | |
135 | * Data:: Examining Data | |
c2bbbb22 | 136 | * Languages:: Using _GDBN__ with Different Languages |
b80282d5 RP |
137 | * Symbols:: Examining the Symbol Table |
138 | * Altering:: Altering Execution | |
c2bbbb22 | 139 | * _GDBN__ Files:: _GDBN__'s Files |
b80282d5 | 140 | * Targets:: Specifying a Debugging Target |
c2bbbb22 | 141 | * Controlling _GDBN__:: Controlling _GDBN__ |
b80282d5 RP |
142 | * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands |
143 | * Emacs:: Using _GDBN__ under GNU Emacs | |
c2bbbb22 | 144 | * _GDBN__ Bugs:: Reporting Bugs in _GDBN__ |
b80282d5 | 145 | * Renamed Commands:: |
c2bbbb22 | 146 | * Installing _GDBN__:: Installing _GDBN__ |
b80282d5 RP |
147 | * Copying:: GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE |
148 | * Index:: Index | |
c2bbbb22 | 149 | |
70b88761 RP |
150 | --- The Detailed Node Listing --- |
151 | ||
152 | Summary of _GDBN__ | |
153 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
154 | * Free Software:: Free Software |
155 | * Contributors:: Contributors to _GDBN__ | |
70b88761 RP |
156 | |
157 | Getting In and Out of _GDBN__ | |
158 | ||
c2bbbb22 RP |
159 | * Starting _GDBN__:: Starting _GDBN__ |
160 | * Leaving _GDBN__:: Leaving _GDBN__ | |
b80282d5 | 161 | * Shell Commands:: Shell Commands |
70b88761 RP |
162 | |
163 | Starting _GDBN__ | |
164 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
165 | * File Options:: Choosing Files |
166 | * Mode Options:: Choosing Modes | |
70b88761 RP |
167 | |
168 | _GDBN__ Commands | |
169 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
170 | * Command Syntax:: Command Syntax |
171 | * Help:: Getting Help | |
70b88761 RP |
172 | |
173 | Running Programs Under _GDBN__ | |
174 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
175 | * Compilation:: Compiling for Debugging |
176 | * Starting:: Starting your Program | |
177 | * Arguments:: Your Program's Arguments | |
178 | * Environment:: Your Program's Environment | |
179 | * Working Directory:: Your Program's Working Directory | |
180 | * Input/Output:: Your Program's Input and Output | |
181 | * Attach:: Debugging an Already-Running Process | |
182 | * Kill Process:: Killing the Child Process | |
70b88761 RP |
183 | |
184 | Stopping and Continuing | |
185 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
186 | * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Exceptions |
187 | * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming Execution | |
188 | * Signals:: Signals | |
70b88761 RP |
189 | |
190 | Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Exceptions | |
191 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
192 | * Set Breaks:: Setting Breakpoints |
193 | * Set Watchpoints:: Setting Watchpoints | |
194 | * Exception Handling:: Breakpoints and Exceptions | |
195 | * Delete Breaks:: Deleting Breakpoints | |
196 | * Disabling:: Disabling Breakpoints | |
197 | * Conditions:: Break Conditions | |
198 | * Break Commands:: Breakpoint Command Lists | |
199 | * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint Menus | |
c2bbbb22 | 200 | * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints'' |
70b88761 RP |
201 | |
202 | Examining the Stack | |
203 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
204 | * Frames:: Stack Frames |
205 | * Backtrace:: Backtraces | |
206 | * Selection:: Selecting a Frame | |
207 | * Frame Info:: Information on a Frame | |
70b88761 RP |
208 | |
209 | Examining Source Files | |
210 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
211 | * List:: Printing Source Lines |
212 | * Search:: Searching Source Files | |
213 | * Source Path:: Specifying Source Directories | |
214 | * Machine Code:: Source and Machine Code | |
70b88761 RP |
215 | |
216 | Examining Data | |
217 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
218 | * Expressions:: Expressions |
219 | * Variables:: Program Variables | |
220 | * Arrays:: Artificial Arrays | |
221 | * Output formats:: Output formats | |
222 | * Memory:: Examining Memory | |
223 | * Auto Display:: Automatic Display | |
224 | * Print Settings:: Print Settings | |
225 | * Value History:: Value History | |
226 | * Convenience Vars:: Convenience Variables | |
227 | * Registers:: Registers | |
228 | * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating Point Hardware | |
70b88761 | 229 | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
230 | Using GDB with Different Languages |
231 | ||
232 | * Setting:: Switching between source languages | |
233 | * Show:: Displaying the language | |
234 | * Checks:: Type and Range checks | |
235 | * Support:: Supported languages | |
236 | ||
237 | Switching between source languages | |
238 | ||
239 | * Manually:: Setting the working language manually | |
240 | * Automatically:: Having GDB infer the source language | |
241 | ||
242 | Type and range Checking | |
243 | ||
244 | * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking | |
245 | * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking | |
246 | ||
247 | Supported Languages | |
248 | ||
249 | * C:: C and C++ | |
250 | * Modula-2:: Modula-2 | |
251 | ||
252 | C and C++ | |
253 | ||
254 | * C Operators:: C and C++ Operators | |
255 | * C Constants:: C and C++ Constants | |
256 | * Cplusplus expressions:: C++ Expressions | |
257 | * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++ | |
258 | * C Checks:: C and C++ Type and Range Checks | |
259 | * Debugging C:: _GDBN__ and C | |
260 | * Debugging C plus plus:: Special features for C++ | |
261 | ||
262 | Modula-2 | |
263 | ||
264 | * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators | |
265 | * Builtin Func/Proc:: Built-in Functions and Procedures | |
266 | * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 Constants | |
267 | * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2 | |
268 | * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2 | |
269 | * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 Type and Range Checks | |
270 | * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.} | |
271 | * GDB/M2:: GDB and Modula-2 | |
272 | ||
70b88761 RP |
273 | Altering Execution |
274 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
275 | * Assignment:: Assignment to Variables |
276 | * Jumping:: Continuing at a Different Address | |
277 | * Signaling:: Giving the Program a Signal | |
278 | * Returning:: Returning from a Function | |
279 | * Calling:: Calling your Program's Functions | |
c338a2fd | 280 | * Patching:: Patching your Program |
70b88761 RP |
281 | |
282 | _GDBN__'s Files | |
283 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
284 | * Files:: Commands to Specify Files |
285 | * Symbol Errors:: Errors Reading Symbol Files | |
70b88761 RP |
286 | |
287 | Specifying a Debugging Target | |
288 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
289 | * Active Targets:: Active Targets |
290 | * Target Commands:: Commands for Managing Targets | |
291 | * Remote:: Remote Debugging | |
70b88761 RP |
292 | |
293 | Remote Debugging | |
294 | ||
c2bbbb22 RP |
295 | * i960-Nindy Remote:: _GDBN__ with a Remote i960 (Nindy) |
296 | * EB29K Remote:: _GDBN__ with a Remote EB29K | |
297 | * VxWorks Remote:: _GDBN__ and VxWorks | |
70b88761 RP |
298 | |
299 | _GDBN__ with a Remote i960 (Nindy) | |
300 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
301 | * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy |
302 | * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy | |
303 | * Nindy reset:: Nindy Reset Command | |
70b88761 RP |
304 | |
305 | _GDBN__ with a Remote EB29K | |
306 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
307 | * Comms (EB29K):: Communications Setup |
308 | * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging | |
309 | * Remote Log:: Remote Log | |
70b88761 RP |
310 | |
311 | _GDBN__ and VxWorks | |
312 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
313 | * VxWorks connection:: Connecting to VxWorks |
314 | * VxWorks download:: VxWorks Download | |
315 | * VxWorks attach:: Running Tasks | |
70b88761 RP |
316 | |
317 | Controlling _GDBN__ | |
318 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
319 | * Prompt:: Prompt |
320 | * Editing:: Command Editing | |
321 | * History:: Command History | |
322 | * Screen Size:: Screen Size | |
323 | * Numbers:: Numbers | |
324 | * Messages/Warnings:: Optional Warnings and Messages | |
70b88761 RP |
325 | |
326 | Canned Sequences of Commands | |
327 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
328 | * Define:: User-Defined Commands |
329 | * Command Files:: Command Files | |
330 | * Output:: Commands for Controlled Output | |
70b88761 RP |
331 | |
332 | Reporting Bugs in _GDBN__ | |
333 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
334 | * Bug Criteria:: Have You Found a Bug? |
335 | * Bug Reporting:: How to Report Bugs | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
336 | |
337 | Installing GDB | |
338 | ||
339 | * Subdirectories:: Configuration subdirectories | |
340 | * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets | |
341 | * configure Options:: Summary of options for configure | |
342 | * Formatting Manual:: How to format and print GDB documentation | |
70b88761 RP |
343 | @end menu |
344 | ||
345 | @node Summary, New Features, Top, Top | |
346 | @unnumbered Summary of _GDBN__ | |
347 | ||
348 | The purpose of a debugger such as _GDBN__ is to allow you to see what is | |
349 | going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another | |
350 | program was doing at the moment it crashed. | |
351 | ||
352 | _GDBN__ can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of | |
353 | these) to help you catch bugs in the act: | |
354 | ||
355 | @itemize @bullet | |
356 | @item | |
357 | Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior. | |
358 | ||
359 | @item | |
360 | Make your program stop on specified conditions. | |
361 | ||
362 | @item | |
363 | Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped. | |
364 | ||
365 | @item | |
366 | Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the | |
367 | effects of one bug and go on to learn about another. | |
368 | @end itemize | |
369 | ||
c2bbbb22 RP |
370 | You can use _GDBN__ to debug programs written in C, C++, and Modula-2. |
371 | Fortran support will be added when a GNU Fortran compiler is ready. | |
70b88761 RP |
372 | |
373 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
374 | * Free Software:: Free Software |
375 | * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB | |
70b88761 RP |
376 | @end menu |
377 | ||
378 | @node Free Software, Contributors, Summary, Summary | |
379 | @unnumberedsec Free Software | |
380 | _GDBN__ is @dfn{free software}, protected by the GNU General Public License (GPL). | |
381 | The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed | |
382 | program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the | |
383 | freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to | |
384 | the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies. | |
385 | Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the | |
386 | Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms. | |
387 | ||
388 | Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that | |
389 | you have these freedoms and that you can't take these freedoms away | |
390 | from anyone else. | |
391 | ||
392 | @c FIXME: (passim) go through all xrefs, expanding to use text headings | |
393 | For full details, @pxref{Copying}. | |
394 | @node Contributors, , Free Software, Summary | |
395 | @unnumberedsec Contributors to GDB | |
396 | ||
397 | Richard Stallman was the original author of GDB, and of many other GNU | |
398 | programs. Many others have contributed to its development. This | |
399 | section attempts to credit major contributors. One of the virtues of | |
400 | free software is that everyone is free to contribute to it; with | |
401 | regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The file | |
402 | @file{ChangeLog} in the GDB distribution approximates a blow-by-blow | |
403 | account. | |
404 | ||
405 | Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time. | |
406 | ||
407 | @quotation | |
408 | @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you | |
409 | or your friends (or enemies; let's be evenhanded) have been unfairly | |
410 | omitted from this list, we would like to add your names! | |
411 | @end quotation | |
412 | ||
413 | So that they may not regard their long labor as thankless, we | |
b80282d5 | 414 | particularly thank those who shepherded GDB through major releases: John |
3e0d0a27 | 415 | Gilmore (releases _GDB_VN__, 4.0); Jim Kingdon (releases 3.9, 3.5, 3.4, 3.3); |
c2bbbb22 RP |
416 | and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, 3.0). As major maintainer of GDB |
417 | for some period, each contributed significantly to the structure, | |
418 | stability, and capabilities of the entire debugger. | |
70b88761 RP |
419 | |
420 | Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Pete TerMaat, Chris | |
421 | Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8. | |
422 | ||
423 | Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the GNU C++ support in GDB, | |
424 | with significant additional contributions from Per Bothner. James | |
425 | Clark wrote the GNU C++ demangler. Early work on C++ was by Peter | |
426 | TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading to release 3.0). | |
427 | ||
3e0d0a27 | 428 | GDB _GDB_VN__ uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple |
70b88761 RP |
429 | object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of V. Gumby |
430 | Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore. | |
431 | ||
432 | David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did | |
433 | the original support for encapsulated COFF. | |
434 | ||
435 | Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support. | |
436 | Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS | |
437 | support. Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support. Chris | |
438 | Hanson improved the HP9000 support. Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki | |
439 | Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support. David Johnson contributed | |
440 | Encore Umax support. Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support. | |
441 | Keith Packard contributed NS32K support. Doug Rabson contributed | |
442 | Acorn Risc Machine support. Chris Smith contributed Convex support | |
443 | (and Fortran debugging). Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support. | |
444 | Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support. Tim Tucker contributed | |
445 | support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode. Pace Willison | |
446 | contributed Intel 386 support. Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry | |
447 | support. | |
448 | ||
c338a2fd RP |
449 | Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared |
450 | libraries. | |
70b88761 RP |
451 | |
452 | Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that GDB and GAS agree about | |
453 | several machine instruction sets. | |
454 | ||
455 | Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped | |
456 | develop remote debugging. Intel Corporation and Wind River Systems | |
457 | contributed remote debugging modules for their products. | |
458 | ||
459 | Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing | |
460 | command-line editing and command history. | |
461 | ||
c2bbbb22 RP |
462 | Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code and |
463 | the Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this | |
464 | manual. | |
465 | ||
70b88761 RP |
466 | @node New Features, Sample Session, Summary, Top |
467 | @unnumbered New Features since _GDBN__ version 3.5 | |
468 | ||
469 | @table @emph | |
470 | @item Targets | |
471 | Using the new command @code{target}, you can select at runtime whether | |
472 | you are debugging local files, local processes, standalone systems over | |
b80282d5 RP |
473 | a serial port, realtime systems over a TCP/IP connection, etc. The |
474 | command @code{load} can download programs into a remote system. Serial | |
475 | stubs are available for Motorola 680x0 and Intel 80386 remote systems; | |
476 | _GDBN__ also supports debugging realtime processes running under | |
477 | VxWorks, using SunRPC Remote Procedure Calls over TCP/IP to talk to a | |
478 | debugger stub on the target system. Internally, _GDBN__ now uses a | |
479 | function vector to mediate access to different targets; if you need to | |
480 | add your own support for a remote protocol, this makes it much easier. | |
70b88761 RP |
481 | |
482 | @item Watchpoints | |
483 | _GDBN__ now sports watchpoints as well as breakpoints. You can use a | |
484 | watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an expression | |
485 | changes, without having to predict a particular place in your program | |
486 | where this may happen. | |
487 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
488 | @item Wide Output |
489 | Commands that issue wide output now insert newlines at places designed | |
490 | to make the output more readable. | |
491 | ||
70b88761 | 492 | @item Object Code Formats |
b80282d5 | 493 | _GDBN__ uses a new library called the Binary File Descriptor (BFD) |
3d3ab540 RP |
494 | Library to permit it to switch dynamically, without reconfiguration or |
495 | recompilation, between different object-file formats. Formats currently | |
496 | supported are COFF, a.out, and the Intel 960 b.out; files may be read as | |
497 | .o's, archive libraries, or core dumps. BFD is available as a | |
498 | subroutine library so that other programs may take advantage of it, and | |
499 | the other GNU binary utilities are being converted to use it. | |
70b88761 | 500 | |
b80282d5 | 501 | @item Configuration and Ports |
70b88761 | 502 | Compile-time configuration (to select a particular architecture and |
7463aadd | 503 | operating system) is much easier. The script @code{configure} now |
3d3ab540 | 504 | allows you to configure _GDBN__ as either a native debugger or a |
b80282d5 RP |
505 | cross-debugger. @xref{Installing _GDBN__} for details on how to |
506 | configure and on what architectures are now available. | |
70b88761 RP |
507 | |
508 | @item Interaction | |
509 | The user interface to _GDBN__'s control variables has been simplified | |
510 | and consolidated in two commands, @code{set} and @code{show}. Output | |
511 | lines are now broken at readable places, rather than overflowing onto | |
512 | the next line. You can suppress output of machine-level addresses, | |
513 | displaying only source language information. | |
514 | ||
515 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
516 | @item C++ |
517 | _GDBN__ now supports C++ multiple inheritance (if used with a GCC | |
518 | version 2 compiler), and also has limited support for C++ exception | |
519 | handling, with the commands @code{catch} and @code{info catch}: _GDBN__ | |
520 | can break when an exception is raised, before the stack is peeled back | |
521 | to the exception handler's context. | |
70b88761 | 522 | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
523 | @item Modula-2 |
524 | _GDBN__ now has preliminary support for the GNU Modula-2 compiler, | |
525 | currently under development at the State University of New York at | |
526 | Buffalo. Coordinated development of both _GDBN__ and the GNU Modula-2 | |
527 | compiler will continue through the fall of 1991 and into 1992. Other | |
528 | Modula-2 compilers are currently not supported, and attempting to debug | |
529 | programs compiled with them will likely result in an error as the symbol | |
530 | table of the executable is read in. | |
531 | ||
70b88761 RP |
532 | @item Command Rationalization |
533 | Many _GDBN__ commands have been renamed to make them easier to remember | |
534 | and use. In particular, the subcommands of @code{info} and | |
535 | @code{show}/@code{set} are grouped to make the former refer to the state | |
536 | of your program, and the latter refer to the state of _GDBN__ itself. | |
537 | @xref{Renamed Commands}, for details on what commands were renamed. | |
538 | ||
70b88761 | 539 | @item Shared Libraries |
3e0d0a27 | 540 | _GDBN__ _GDB_VN__ can debug programs and core files that use SunOS shared |
b80282d5 RP |
541 | libraries. You can load symbols from a shared library with the command |
542 | @code{sharedlibrary} (@pxref{Files}). | |
543 | ||
544 | @item Reference Card | |
3e0d0a27 | 545 | _GDBN__ _GDB_VN__ has a reference card; @xref{Formatting Manual} for |
b80282d5 | 546 | instructions on printing it. |
70b88761 RP |
547 | |
548 | @item Work in Progress | |
549 | Kernel debugging for BSD and Mach systems; Tahoe and HPPA architecture | |
550 | support. | |
551 | ||
552 | @end table | |
553 | ||
554 | @node Sample Session, Invocation, New Features, Top | |
555 | @chapter A Sample _GDBN__ Session | |
556 | ||
557 | You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about _GDBN__. | |
558 | However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the | |
559 | debugger. This chapter illustrates these commands. | |
560 | ||
561 | @iftex | |
562 | In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @i{input}, | |
563 | to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output. | |
564 | @end iftex | |
565 | ||
566 | @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where | |
567 | @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use. | |
568 | _0__ | |
569 | One of the preliminary versions of GNU @code{m4} (a generic macro | |
570 | processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its | |
571 | quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro's | |
572 | definition in another stop working. In the following short @code{m4} | |
573 | session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we | |
574 | then use the @code{m4} builtin @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the | |
575 | same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to | |
576 | @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same | |
577 | procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}: | |
578 | ||
579 | @smallexample | |
580 | $ @i{cd gnu/m4} | |
581 | $ @i{./m4} | |
582 | @i{define(foo,0000)} | |
583 | ||
584 | @i{foo} | |
585 | 0000 | |
586 | @i{define(bar,defn(`foo'))} | |
587 | ||
588 | @i{bar} | |
589 | 0000 | |
590 | @i{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)} | |
591 | ||
592 | @i{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))} | |
593 | @i{baz} | |
594 | @i{C-d} | |
595 | m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string | |
596 | @end smallexample | |
597 | ||
598 | @noindent | |
599 | Let's use _GDBN__ to try to see what's going on. | |
600 | ||
601 | @smallexample | |
602 | $ @i{_GDBP__ m4} | |
c338a2fd RP |
603 | GDB is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies of it |
604 | under certain conditions; type "info copying" to see the conditions. | |
605 | There is absolutely no warranty for GDB; type "info warranty" for details. | |
606 | GDB _GDB_VN__, Copyright 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc... | |
70b88761 RP |
607 | (_GDBP__) |
608 | @end smallexample | |
609 | ||
610 | @noindent | |
611 | _GDBN__ reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the rest | |
612 | when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly. We | |
613 | then tell _GDBN__ to use a narrower display width than usual, so | |
614 | that examples will fit in this manual. | |
615 | ||
616 | @smallexample | |
617 | (_GDBP__) @i{set width 70} | |
618 | @end smallexample | |
619 | ||
620 | @noindent | |
621 | Let's see how the @code{m4} builtin @code{changequote} works. | |
622 | Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is | |
623 | @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with _GDBN__'s | |
624 | @code{break} command. | |
625 | ||
626 | @smallexample | |
627 | (_GDBP__) @i{break m4_changequote} | |
628 | Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879. | |
629 | @end smallexample | |
630 | ||
631 | @noindent | |
632 | Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under _GDBN__ | |
633 | control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote} | |
634 | subroutine, the program runs as usual: | |
635 | ||
636 | @smallexample | |
637 | (_GDBP__) @i{run} | |
638 | Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4 | |
639 | @i{define(foo,0000)} | |
640 | ||
641 | @i{foo} | |
642 | 0000 | |
643 | @end smallexample | |
644 | ||
645 | @noindent | |
646 | To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. _GDBN__ | |
647 | suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the | |
648 | context where it stops. | |
649 | ||
650 | @smallexample | |
651 | @i{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)} | |
652 | ||
653 | Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70) at builtin.c:879 | |
654 | 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]), argc, 1, 3)) | |
655 | @end smallexample | |
656 | ||
657 | @noindent | |
658 | Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to | |
659 | the next line of the current function. | |
660 | ||
661 | @smallexample | |
662 | (_GDBP__) @i{n} | |
663 | 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1]) : nil, | |
664 | @end smallexample | |
665 | ||
666 | @noindent | |
667 | @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it | |
668 | by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}. | |
669 | @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any} | |
670 | subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}. | |
671 | ||
672 | @smallexample | |
673 | (_GDBP__) @i{s} | |
674 | set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>") | |
675 | at input.c:530 | |
676 | 530 if (lquote != def_lquote) | |
677 | @end smallexample | |
678 | ||
679 | @noindent | |
680 | The summary display showing the subroutine where @code{m4} is now | |
681 | suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. We can | |
682 | use the @code{backtrace} command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), | |
683 | to see where we are in the stack: it displays a stack frame for each | |
684 | active subroutine. | |
685 | ||
686 | @smallexample | |
687 | (_GDBP__) @i{bt} | |
688 | #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>") | |
689 | at input.c:530 | |
690 | #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70) at builtin.c:882 | |
691 | #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242 | |
692 | #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30) | |
693 | at macro.c:71 | |
694 | #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40 | |
695 | #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195 | |
696 | @end smallexample | |
697 | ||
698 | @noindent | |
699 | Let's step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two | |
700 | times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid | |
701 | falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine. | |
702 | @smallexample | |
703 | (_GDBP__) @i{s} | |
704 | 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote) | |
705 | (_GDBP__) @i{s} | |
706 | 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote :\ | |
707 | xstrdup(lq); | |
708 | (_GDBP__) @i{n} | |
709 | 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote : xstrdup\ | |
710 | (rq); | |
711 | (_GDBP__) @i{n} | |
712 | 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote); | |
713 | @end smallexample | |
714 | ||
715 | @noindent | |
716 | The last line displayed looks a little odd; let's examine the variables | |
717 | @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left | |
718 | and right quotes we specified. We can use the command @code{p} | |
719 | (@code{print}) to see their values. | |
720 | ||
721 | @smallexample | |
722 | (_GDBP__) @i{p lquote} | |
723 | $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>" | |
724 | (_GDBP__) @i{p rquote} | |
725 | $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>" | |
726 | @end smallexample | |
727 | ||
728 | @noindent | |
729 | @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes. | |
730 | Let's look at some context; we can display ten lines of source | |
731 | surrounding the current line, with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command. | |
732 | ||
733 | @smallexample | |
734 | (_GDBP__) @i{l} | |
735 | 533 xfree(rquote); | |
736 | 534 | |
737 | 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote : xstrdup\ | |
738 | (lq); | |
739 | 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote : xstrdup\ | |
740 | (rq); | |
741 | 537 | |
742 | 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote); | |
743 | 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote); | |
744 | 540 @} | |
745 | 541 | |
746 | 542 void | |
747 | @end smallexample | |
748 | ||
749 | @noindent | |
750 | Let's step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and | |
751 | @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables. | |
752 | ||
753 | @smallexample | |
754 | (_GDBP__) @i{n} | |
755 | 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote); | |
756 | (_GDBP__) @i{n} | |
757 | 540 @} | |
758 | (_GDBP__) @i{p len_lquote} | |
759 | $3 = 9 | |
760 | (_GDBP__) @i{p len_rquote} | |
761 | $4 = 7 | |
762 | @end smallexample | |
763 | ||
764 | @noindent | |
765 | That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and | |
766 | @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and | |
767 | @code{rquote} respectively. Let's try setting them to better values. | |
768 | We can use the @code{p} command for this, since it'll print the value of | |
769 | any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and | |
770 | assignments. | |
771 | ||
772 | @smallexample | |
773 | (_GDBP__) p len_lquote=strlen(lquote) | |
774 | $5 = 7 | |
775 | (_GDBP__) p len_rquote=strlen(rquote) | |
776 | $6 = 9 | |
777 | @end smallexample | |
778 | ||
779 | @noindent | |
780 | Let's see if that fixes the problem of using the new quotes with the | |
781 | @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}. We can allow @code{m4} to continue | |
782 | executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the | |
783 | example that caused trouble initially: | |
784 | ||
785 | @smallexample | |
786 | (_GDBP__) @i{c} | |
787 | Continuing. | |
788 | ||
789 | @i{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))} | |
790 | ||
791 | baz | |
792 | 0000 | |
793 | @end smallexample | |
794 | ||
795 | @noindent | |
796 | Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The | |
797 | problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong | |
798 | lengths. We'll let @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input. | |
799 | ||
800 | @smallexample | |
801 | @i{C-d} | |
802 | Program exited normally. | |
803 | @end smallexample | |
804 | ||
805 | @noindent | |
806 | The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from _GDBN__; it | |
807 | indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our _GDBN__ | |
808 | session with the _GDBN__ @code{quit} command. | |
809 | ||
810 | @smallexample | |
811 | (_GDBP__) @i{quit} | |
70b88761 RP |
812 | _1__@end smallexample |
813 | ||
814 | @node Invocation, Commands, Sample Session, Top | |
815 | @chapter Getting In and Out of _GDBN__ | |
816 | ||
817 | @menu | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
818 | * Starting _GDBN__:: Starting _GDBN__ |
819 | * Leaving _GDBN__:: Leaving _GDBN__ | |
b80282d5 | 820 | * Shell Commands:: Shell Commands |
70b88761 RP |
821 | @end menu |
822 | ||
823 | @node Starting _GDBN__, Leaving _GDBN__, Invocation, Invocation | |
824 | @section Starting _GDBN__ | |
825 | ||
826 | _GDBN__ is invoked with the shell command @code{_GDBP__}. Once started, | |
827 | it reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit. | |
828 | ||
829 | You can run @code{_GDBP__} with no arguments or options; but the most | |
830 | usual way to start _GDBN__ is with one argument or two, specifying an | |
831 | executable program as the argument: | |
832 | @example | |
833 | _GDBP__ program | |
834 | @end example | |
835 | @noindent | |
836 | You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified: | |
837 | @example | |
838 | _GDBP__ program core | |
839 | @end example | |
840 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
841 | You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want |
842 | to debug a running process: | |
843 | @example | |
844 | _GDBP__ program 1234 | |
845 | @end example | |
846 | @noindent | |
847 | would attach _GDBN__ to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file | |
848 | named @file{1234}; _GDBN__ does check for a core file first). | |
849 | ||
70b88761 RP |
850 | @noindent |
851 | You can further control how _GDBN__ starts up by using command-line | |
852 | options. _GDBN__ itself can remind you of the options available: | |
853 | @example | |
854 | _GDBP__ -help | |
855 | @end example | |
856 | @noindent | |
857 | will display all available options and briefly describe their use | |
858 | (@samp{_GDBP__ -h} is a shorter equivalent). | |
859 | ||
860 | All options and command line arguments you give are processed | |
861 | in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the | |
862 | @samp{-x} option is used. | |
863 | ||
864 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
865 | * File Options:: Choosing Files |
866 | * Mode Options:: Choosing Modes | |
70b88761 RP |
867 | _if__(!_GENERIC__) |
868 | _include__(gdbinv-m.m4)_dnl__ | |
869 | _fi__(!_GENERIC__) | |
870 | @end menu | |
871 | ||
872 | @node File Options, Mode Options, Starting _GDBN__, Starting _GDBN__ | |
873 | @subsection Choosing Files | |
874 | ||
875 | As shown above, any arguments other than options specify an executable | |
876 | file and core file; that is, the first argument encountered with no | |
877 | associated option flag is equivalent to a @samp{-se} option, and the | |
878 | second, if any, is equivalent to a @samp{-c} option. Many options have | |
879 | both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also | |
880 | recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is | |
881 | present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option | |
882 | arguments with @samp{+} rather than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the | |
883 | more usual convention.) | |
884 | ||
885 | @table @code | |
886 | @item -symbols=@var{file} | |
887 | @itemx -s @var{file} | |
888 | Read symbol table from file @var{file}. | |
889 | ||
890 | @item -exec=@var{file} | |
891 | @itemx -e @var{file} | |
892 | Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when | |
893 | appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core | |
894 | dump. | |
895 | ||
3d3ab540 | 896 | @item -se=@var{file} |
70b88761 RP |
897 | Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable |
898 | file. | |
899 | ||
900 | @item -core=@var{file} | |
901 | @itemx -c @var{file} | |
902 | Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine. | |
903 | ||
904 | @item -command=@var{file} | |
905 | @itemx -x @var{file} | |
906 | Execute _GDBN__ commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command Files}. | |
907 | ||
908 | @item -directory=@var{directory} | |
909 | @itemx -d @var{directory} | |
910 | Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files. | |
911 | @end table | |
912 | ||
913 | _if__(!_GENERIC__) | |
c2bbbb22 | 914 | @node Mode Options, Mode Options, File Options, Starting _GDBN__ |
70b88761 RP |
915 | _fi__(!_GENERIC__) |
916 | _if__(_GENERIC__) | |
917 | @node Mode Options, , File Options, Starting _GDBN__ | |
918 | _fi__(_GENERIC__) | |
919 | @subsection Choosing Modes | |
920 | ||
921 | @table @code | |
922 | @item -nx | |
923 | @itemx -n | |
924 | Do not execute commands from any @file{_GDBINIT__} initialization files. | |
925 | Normally, the commands in these files are executed after all the | |
926 | command options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command | |
927 | Files}. | |
928 | ||
929 | @item -quiet | |
930 | @itemx -q | |
931 | ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These | |
c338a2fd | 932 | messages are also suppressed in batch mode. |
70b88761 RP |
933 | |
934 | @item -batch | |
935 | Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command | |
936 | files specified with @samp{-x} (and @file{_GDBINIT__}, if not inhibited). | |
937 | Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the _GDBN__ | |
938 | commands in the command files. | |
939 | ||
940 | Batch mode may be useful for running _GDBN__ as a filter, for example to | |
941 | download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this | |
942 | more useful, the message | |
943 | @example | |
944 | Program exited normally. | |
945 | @end example | |
946 | @noindent | |
947 | (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under _GDBN__ control | |
948 | terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode. | |
949 | ||
3d3ab540 | 950 | @item -cd=@var{directory} |
70b88761 RP |
951 | Run _GDBN__ using @var{directory} as its working directory, |
952 | instead of the current directory. | |
953 | ||
954 | @item -fullname | |
955 | @itemx -f | |
956 | Emacs sets this option when it runs _GDBN__ as a subprocess. It tells _GDBN__ | |
957 | to output the full file name and line number in a standard, | |
958 | recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which | |
959 | includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks | |
960 | like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number | |
961 | and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The | |
962 | Emacs-to-_GDBN__ interface program uses the two @samp{\032} characters as | |
963 | a signal to display the source code for the frame. | |
964 | ||
965 | @item -b @var{bps} | |
966 | Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial | |
967 | interface used by _GDBN__ for remote debugging. | |
968 | ||
3d3ab540 | 969 | @item -tty=@var{device} |
70b88761 RP |
970 | Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output. |
971 | @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there's more to -tty. Investigate. | |
972 | @end table | |
973 | ||
974 | _if__(!_GENERIC__) | |
975 | _include__(gdbinv-s.m4) | |
976 | _fi__(!_GENERIC__) | |
977 | ||
978 | @node Leaving _GDBN__, Shell Commands, Starting _GDBN__, Invocation | |
979 | @section Leaving _GDBN__ | |
980 | @cindex exiting _GDBN__ | |
981 | @table @code | |
982 | @item quit | |
983 | @kindex quit | |
984 | @kindex q | |
985 | To exit _GDBN__, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated @code{q}), or type | |
986 | an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). | |
987 | @end table | |
988 | ||
989 | @cindex interrupt | |
990 | An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) will not exit from _GDBN__, but rather | |
991 | will terminate the action of any _GDBN__ command that is in progress and | |
992 | return to _GDBN__ command level. It is safe to type the interrupt | |
993 | character at any time because _GDBN__ does not allow it to take effect | |
994 | until a time when it is safe. | |
995 | ||
996 | If you've been using _GDBN__ to control an attached process or device, | |
997 | you can release it with the @code{detach} command; @pxref{Attach}. | |
998 | ||
999 | @node Shell Commands, , Leaving _GDBN__, Invocation | |
1000 | @section Shell Commands | |
1001 | If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your | |
1002 | debugging session, there's no need to leave or suspend _GDBN__; you can | |
1003 | just use the @code{shell} command. | |
1004 | ||
1005 | @table @code | |
1006 | @item shell @var{command string} | |
1007 | @kindex shell | |
1008 | @cindex shell escape | |
1009 | Directs _GDBN__ to invoke an inferior shell to execute @var{command | |
1010 | string}. If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} is used | |
1011 | for the name of the shell to run. Otherwise _GDBN__ uses | |
1012 | @code{/bin/sh}. | |
1013 | @end table | |
1014 | ||
1015 | The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments. | |
1016 | You don't have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in _GDBN__: | |
1017 | ||
1018 | @table @code | |
1019 | @item make @var{make-args} | |
1020 | @kindex make | |
1021 | @cindex calling make | |
1022 | Causes _GDBN__ to execute an inferior @code{make} program with the specified | |
1023 | arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}. | |
1024 | @end table | |
1025 | ||
1026 | @node Commands, Running, Invocation, Top | |
1027 | @chapter _GDBN__ Commands | |
1028 | ||
1029 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
1030 | * Command Syntax:: Command Syntax |
1031 | * Help:: Getting Help | |
70b88761 RP |
1032 | @end menu |
1033 | ||
1034 | @node Command Syntax, Help, Commands, Commands | |
1035 | @section Command Syntax | |
1036 | A _GDBN__ command is a single line of input. There is no limit on how long | |
1037 | it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by arguments | |
1038 | whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the command | |
1039 | @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to step, | |
1040 | as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command with | |
1041 | no arguments. Some command names do not allow any arguments. | |
1042 | ||
1043 | @cindex abbreviation | |
1044 | _GDBN__ command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is | |
1045 | unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the | |
1046 | documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous | |
1047 | abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as | |
1048 | equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose | |
1049 | names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as | |
7463aadd | 1050 | arguments to the @code{help} command. |
70b88761 RP |
1051 | |
1052 | @cindex repeating commands | |
1053 | @kindex RET | |
1054 | A blank line as input to _GDBN__ (typing just @key{RET}) means to | |
1055 | repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run}) | |
1056 | will not repeat this way; these are commands for which unintentional | |
1057 | repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to | |
1058 | repeat. | |
1059 | ||
1060 | The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with | |
1061 | @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating | |
1062 | exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory. | |
1063 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
1064 | _GDBN__ can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy |
1065 | output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more} | |
1066 | (@pxref{Screen Size}). Since it's easy to press one @key{RET} too many | |
1067 | in this situation, _GDBN__ disables command repetition after any command | |
1068 | that generates this sort of display. | |
1069 | ||
70b88761 RP |
1070 | @kindex # |
1071 | @cindex comment | |
1072 | A line of input starting with @kbd{#} is a comment; it does nothing. | |
1073 | This is useful mainly in command files (@xref{Command Files}). | |
1074 | ||
1075 | @node Help, , Command Syntax, Commands | |
1076 | @section Getting Help | |
1077 | @cindex online documentation | |
1078 | @kindex help | |
1079 | You can always ask _GDBN__ itself for information on its commands, using the | |
1080 | command @code{help}. | |
1081 | ||
1082 | @table @code | |
1083 | @item help | |
1084 | @itemx h | |
1085 | @kindex h | |
1086 | You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to | |
1087 | display a short list of named classes of commands: | |
1088 | @smallexample | |
1089 | (_GDBP__) help | |
1090 | List of classes of commands: | |
1091 | ||
1092 | running -- Running the program | |
1093 | stack -- Examining the stack | |
1094 | data -- Examining data | |
1095 | breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points | |
1096 | files -- Specifying and examining files | |
1097 | status -- Status inquiries | |
1098 | support -- Support facilities | |
1099 | user-defined -- User-defined commands | |
1100 | aliases -- Aliases of other commands | |
1101 | obscure -- Obscure features | |
1102 | ||
1103 | Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of commands in that class. | |
1104 | Type "help" followed by command name for full documentation. | |
1105 | Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous. | |
1106 | (_GDBP__) | |
1107 | @end smallexample | |
1108 | ||
1109 | @item help @var{class} | |
1110 | Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a | |
1111 | list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the | |
1112 | help display for the class @code{status}: | |
1113 | @smallexample | |
1114 | (_GDBP__) help status | |
1115 | Status inquiries. | |
1116 | ||
1117 | List of commands: | |
1118 | ||
1119 | show -- Generic command for showing things set with "set" | |
1120 | info -- Generic command for printing status | |
1121 | ||
1122 | Type "help" followed by command name for full documentation. | |
1123 | Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous. | |
1124 | (_GDBP__) | |
1125 | @end smallexample | |
1126 | ||
1127 | @item help @var{command} | |
1128 | With a command name as @code{help} argument, _GDBN__ will display a | |
1129 | short paragraph on how to use that command. | |
1130 | @end table | |
1131 | ||
1132 | In addition to @code{help}, you can use the _GDBN__ commands @code{info} | |
1133 | and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state | |
1134 | of _GDBN__ itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this | |
1135 | manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings | |
1136 | under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to | |
1137 | all the sub-commands. | |
1138 | @c FIXME: @pxref{Index} used to be here, but even though it shows up in | |
1139 | @c FIXME...the 'aux' file with a pageno the xref can't find it. | |
1140 | ||
1141 | @c @group | |
1142 | @table @code | |
1143 | @item info | |
1144 | @kindex info | |
1145 | @kindex i | |
1146 | This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your | |
1147 | program; for example, it can list the arguments given to your program | |
1148 | (@code{info args}), the registers currently in use (@code{info | |
1149 | registers}), or the breakpoints you've set (@code{info breakpoints}). | |
1150 | You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with | |
1151 | @w{@code{help info}}. | |
1152 | ||
1153 | @kindex show | |
1154 | @item show | |
1155 | In contrast, @code{show} is for describing the state of _GDBN__ itself. | |
1156 | You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the | |
1157 | related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number | |
1158 | system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire | |
1159 | which is currently in use with @code{show radix}. | |
1160 | ||
1161 | @kindex info set | |
1162 | To display all the settable parameters and their current | |
1163 | values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use | |
1164 | @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display. | |
1165 | @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of | |
1166 | @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else, | |
1167 | @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"? | |
1168 | @end table | |
1169 | @c @end group | |
1170 | ||
1171 | Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are | |
1172 | exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands: | |
1173 | ||
1174 | @table @code | |
1175 | @kindex show version | |
3d3ab540 | 1176 | @cindex version number |
70b88761 RP |
1177 | @item show version |
1178 | Show what version of _GDBN__ is running. You should include this | |
1179 | information in _GDBN__ bug-reports. If multiple versions of _GDBN__ are | |
1180 | in use at your site, you may occasionally want to make sure what version | |
1181 | of _GDBN__ you're running; as _GDBN__ evolves, new commands are | |
1182 | introduced, and old ones may wither away. The version number is also | |
1183 | announced when you start _GDBN__ with no arguments. | |
1184 | ||
1185 | @kindex show copying | |
1186 | @item show copying | |
1187 | Display information about permission for copying _GDBN__. | |
1188 | ||
1189 | @kindex show warranty | |
1190 | @item show warranty | |
1191 | Display the GNU ``NO WARRANTY'' statement. | |
1192 | @end table | |
1193 | ||
1194 | @node Running, Stopping, Commands, Top | |
1195 | @chapter Running Programs Under _GDBN__ | |
1196 | ||
1197 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
1198 | * Compilation:: Compiling for Debugging |
1199 | * Starting:: Starting your Program | |
1200 | * Arguments:: Your Program's Arguments | |
1201 | * Environment:: Your Program's Environment | |
1202 | * Working Directory:: Your Program's Working Directory | |
1203 | * Input/Output:: Your Program's Input and Output | |
1204 | * Attach:: Debugging an Already-Running Process | |
1205 | * Kill Process:: Killing the Child Process | |
70b88761 RP |
1206 | @end menu |
1207 | ||
1208 | @node Compilation, Starting, Running, Running | |
1209 | @section Compiling for Debugging | |
1210 | ||
1211 | In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate | |
1212 | debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information | |
1213 | is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each | |
1214 | variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers | |
1215 | and addresses in the executable code. | |
1216 | ||
1217 | To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run | |
1218 | the compiler. | |
1219 | ||
1220 | Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} | |
1221 | options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized | |
1222 | executables containing debugging information. | |
1223 | ||
1224 | The GNU C compiler supports @samp{-g} with or without @samp{-O}, making it | |
1225 | possible to debug optimized code. We recommend that you @emph{always} use | |
1226 | @samp{-g} whenever you compile a program. You may think the program is | |
1227 | correct, but there's no sense in pushing your luck. | |
1228 | ||
1229 | Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just | |
1230 | @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in | |
1231 | doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem, | |
1232 | please report it as a bug (including a test case!). | |
1233 | ||
1234 | Older versions of the GNU C compiler permitted a variant option | |
1235 | @samp{-gg} for debugging information. _GDBN__ no longer supports this | |
1236 | format; if your GNU C compiler has this option, do not use it. | |
1237 | ||
1238 | @ignore | |
1239 | @comment As far as I know, there are no cases in which _GDBN__ will | |
1240 | @comment produce strange output in this case. (but no promises). | |
1241 | If your program includes archives made with the @code{ar} program, and | |
1242 | if the object files used as input to @code{ar} were compiled without the | |
1243 | @samp{-g} option and have names longer than 15 characters, _GDBN__ will get | |
1244 | confused reading the program's symbol table. No error message will be | |
1245 | given, but _GDBN__ may behave strangely. The reason for this problem is a | |
1246 | deficiency in the Unix archive file format, which cannot represent file | |
1247 | names longer than 15 characters. | |
1248 | ||
1249 | To avoid this problem, compile the archive members with the @samp{-g} | |
1250 | option or use shorter file names. Alternatively, use a version of GNU | |
1251 | @code{ar} dated more recently than August 1989. | |
1252 | @end ignore | |
1253 | ||
1254 | ||
1255 | @node Starting, Arguments, Compilation, Running | |
1256 | @section Starting your Program | |
1257 | @cindex starting | |
1258 | @cindex running | |
1259 | @table @code | |
1260 | @item run | |
1261 | @itemx r | |
1262 | @kindex run | |
7463aadd RP |
1263 | Use the @code{run} command to start your program under _GDBN__. You |
1264 | must first specify the program name | |
1265 | _if__(_VXWORKS__) | |
1266 | (except on VxWorks) | |
70b88761 | 1267 | _fi__(_VXWORKS__) |
7463aadd | 1268 | with an argument to _GDBN__ |
70b88761 | 1269 | (@pxref{Invocation}), or using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} |
7463aadd RP |
1270 | command (@pxref{Files}). |
1271 | @refill | |
70b88761 RP |
1272 | @end table |
1273 | ||
1274 | On targets that support processes, @code{run} creates an inferior | |
1275 | process and makes that process run your program. On other targets, | |
1276 | @code{run} jumps to the start of the program. | |
1277 | ||
1278 | The execution of a program is affected by certain information it | |
1279 | receives from its superior. _GDBN__ provides ways to specify this | |
1280 | information, which you must do @i{before} starting the program. (You | |
1281 | can change it after starting the program, but such changes will only affect | |
1282 | the program the next time you start it.) This information may be | |
1283 | divided into four categories: | |
1284 | ||
1285 | @table @asis | |
1286 | @item The @i{arguments.} | |
1287 | You specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the | |
1288 | @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell | |
1289 | is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions | |
1290 | (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in | |
1291 | describing the arguments. In Unix systems, you can control which shell | |
1292 | is used with the @code{SHELL} environment variable. @xref{Arguments}.@refill | |
1293 | ||
1294 | @item The @i{environment.} | |
1295 | Your program normally inherits its environment from _GDBN__, but you can | |
1296 | use the _GDBN__ commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset | |
1297 | environment} to change parts of the environment that will be given to | |
1298 | the program. @xref{Environment}.@refill | |
1299 | ||
1300 | @item The @i{working directory.} | |
1301 | Your program inherits its working directory from _GDBN__. You can set | |
1302 | _GDBN__'s working directory with the @code{cd} command in _GDBN__. | |
1303 | @xref{Working Directory}. | |
1304 | ||
1305 | @item The @i{standard input and output.} | |
1306 | Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and | |
1307 | standard output as _GDBN__ is using. You can redirect input and output | |
1308 | in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to | |
1309 | set a different device for your program. | |
1310 | @xref{Input/Output}. | |
3d3ab540 RP |
1311 | |
1312 | @cindex pipes | |
1313 | @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you can't use | |
1314 | pipes to pass the output of the program you're debugging to another | |
1315 | program; if you attempt this, _GDBN__ is likely to wind up debugging the | |
1316 | wrong program. | |
70b88761 RP |
1317 | @end table |
1318 | ||
1319 | When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute | |
1320 | immediately. @xref{Stopping}, for discussion of how to arrange for your | |
1321 | program to stop. Once your program has been started by the @code{run} | |
1322 | command (and then stopped), you may evaluate expressions that involve | |
1323 | calls to functions in the inferior, using the @code{print} or | |
1324 | @code{call} commands. @xref{Data}. | |
1325 | ||
1326 | If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last | |
1327 | time _GDBN__ read its symbols, _GDBN__ will discard its symbol table and re-read | |
1328 | it. In this process, it tries to retain your current breakpoints. | |
1329 | ||
1330 | @node Arguments, Environment, Starting, Running | |
1331 | @section Your Program's Arguments | |
1332 | ||
1333 | @cindex arguments (to your program) | |
1334 | The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the | |
1335 | @code{run} command. They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard | |
1336 | characters and performs redirection of I/O, and thence to the program. | |
1337 | _GDBN__ uses the shell indicated by your environment variable | |
1338 | @code{SHELL} if it exists; otherwise, _GDBN__ uses @code{/bin/sh}. | |
1339 | ||
1340 | @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous | |
1341 | @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command. | |
1342 | ||
1343 | @kindex set args | |
1344 | @table @code | |
1345 | @item set args | |
1346 | Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If | |
1347 | @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} will execute your program | |
1348 | with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments, | |
1349 | using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run | |
1350 | it again without arguments. | |
1351 | ||
1352 | @item show args | |
1353 | @kindex show args | |
1354 | Show the arguments to give your program when it is started. | |
1355 | @end table | |
1356 | ||
1357 | @node Environment, Working Directory, Arguments, Running | |
1358 | @section Your Program's Environment | |
1359 | ||
1360 | @cindex environment (of your program) | |
1361 | The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and | |
1362 | their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as | |
1363 | your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search | |
1364 | path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with | |
1365 | the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When | |
1366 | debugging, it can be useful to try running the program with a modified | |
1367 | environment without having to start _GDBN__ over again. | |
1368 | ||
1369 | @table @code | |
1370 | @item path @var{directory} | |
1371 | @kindex path | |
1372 | Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable | |
1373 | (the search path for executables), for both _GDBN__ and your program. | |
1374 | You may specify several directory names, separated by @samp{:} or | |
1375 | whitespace. If @var{directory} is already in the path, it is moved to | |
7463aadd RP |
1376 | the front, so it will be searched sooner. |
1377 | ||
1378 | You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current | |
1379 | working directory at the time _GDBN__ searches the path. If you use | |
1380 | @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the | |
1381 | @code{path} command. _GDBN__ fills in the current path where needed in | |
1382 | the @var{directory} argument, before adding it to the search path. | |
70b88761 RP |
1383 | @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it's silly to |
1384 | @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op. | |
1385 | ||
1386 | @item show paths | |
1387 | @kindex show paths | |
1388 | Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH} | |
1389 | environment variable). | |
1390 | ||
1391 | @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]} | |
1392 | @kindex show environment | |
1393 | Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to | |
1394 | your program when it starts. If you don't supply @var{varname}, | |
1395 | print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to | |
1396 | your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}. | |
1397 | ||
7463aadd | 1398 | @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@r{]} @var{value} |
70b88761 RP |
1399 | @kindex set environment |
1400 | Sets environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value | |
1401 | changes for your program only, not for _GDBN__ itself. @var{value} may | |
1402 | be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and | |
1403 | any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value} | |
1404 | parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a | |
1405 | null value. | |
1406 | @c "any string" here doesn't include leading, trailing | |
1407 | @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care? | |
1408 | ||
1409 | For example, this command: | |
1410 | ||
1411 | @example | |
1412 | set env USER = foo | |
1413 | @end example | |
1414 | ||
1415 | @noindent | |
1416 | tells a Unix program, when subsequently run, that its user is named | |
1417 | @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they | |
1418 | are not actually required.) | |
1419 | ||
1420 | @item unset environment @var{varname} | |
1421 | @kindex unset environment | |
1422 | Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your | |
1423 | program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =}; | |
1424 | @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment, | |
1425 | rather than assigning it an empty value. | |
1426 | @end table | |
1427 | ||
1428 | @node Working Directory, Input/Output, Environment, Running | |
1429 | @section Your Program's Working Directory | |
1430 | ||
1431 | @cindex working directory (of your program) | |
1432 | Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its | |
1433 | working directory from the current working directory of _GDBN__. _GDBN__'s | |
1434 | working directory is initially whatever it inherited from its parent | |
1435 | process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new working | |
1436 | directory in _GDBN__ with the @code{cd} command. | |
1437 | ||
1438 | The _GDBN__ working directory also serves as a default for the commands | |
1439 | that specify files for _GDBN__ to operate on. @xref{Files}. | |
1440 | ||
1441 | @table @code | |
1442 | @item cd @var{directory} | |
1443 | @kindex cd | |
1444 | Set _GDBN__'s working directory to @var{directory}. | |
1445 | ||
1446 | @item pwd | |
1447 | @kindex pwd | |
1448 | Print _GDBN__'s working directory. | |
1449 | @end table | |
1450 | ||
1451 | @node Input/Output, Attach, Working Directory, Running | |
1452 | @section Your Program's Input and Output | |
1453 | ||
1454 | @cindex redirection | |
1455 | @cindex i/o | |
1456 | @cindex terminal | |
1457 | By default, the program you run under _GDBN__ does input and output to | |
1458 | the same terminal that _GDBN__ uses. _GDBN__ switches the terminal to | |
1459 | its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal | |
1460 | modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue | |
1461 | running your program. | |
1462 | ||
1463 | @table @code | |
1464 | @item info terminal | |
1465 | @kindex info terminal | |
1466 | Displays _GDBN__'s recorded information about the terminal modes your | |
1467 | program is using. | |
1468 | @end table | |
1469 | ||
1470 | You can redirect the program's input and/or output using shell | |
1471 | redirection with the @code{run} command. For example, | |
1472 | ||
1473 | _0__@example | |
1474 | run > outfile | |
1475 | _1__@end example | |
1476 | ||
1477 | @noindent | |
1478 | starts the program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}. | |
1479 | ||
1480 | @kindex tty | |
1481 | @cindex controlling terminal | |
1482 | Another way to specify where the program should do input and output is | |
1483 | with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as | |
1484 | argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run} | |
1485 | commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child | |
1486 | process, for future @code{run} commands. For example, | |
1487 | ||
1488 | @example | |
1489 | tty /dev/ttyb | |
1490 | @end example | |
1491 | ||
1492 | @noindent | |
1493 | directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands | |
1494 | default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have | |
1495 | that as their controlling terminal. | |
1496 | ||
1497 | An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's | |
1498 | effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling | |
1499 | terminal. | |
1500 | ||
1501 | When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run} | |
1502 | command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input | |
1503 | for _GDBN__ still comes from your terminal. | |
1504 | ||
1505 | @node Attach, Kill Process, Input/Output, Running | |
1506 | @section Debugging an Already-Running Process | |
1507 | @kindex attach | |
1508 | @cindex attach | |
1509 | ||
1510 | @table @code | |
1511 | @item attach @var{process-id} | |
1512 | This command | |
1513 | attaches to a running process---one that was started outside _GDBN__. | |
1514 | (@code{info files} will show your active targets.) The command takes as | |
1515 | argument a process ID. The usual way to find out the process-id of | |
1516 | a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility, or with the @samp{jobs -l} | |
1517 | shell command. | |
1518 | ||
1519 | @code{attach} will not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after | |
1520 | executing the command. | |
1521 | @end table | |
1522 | ||
1523 | To use @code{attach}, you must be debugging in an environment which | |
1524 | supports processes. You must also have permission to send the process a | |
1525 | signal, and it must have the same effective user ID as the _GDBN__ | |
1526 | process. | |
1527 | ||
1528 | When using @code{attach}, you should first use the @code{file} command | |
1529 | to specify the program running in the process and load its symbol table. | |
1530 | @xref{Files}. | |
1531 | ||
1532 | The first thing _GDBN__ does after arranging to debug the specified | |
1533 | process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process | |
1534 | with all the _GDBN__ commands that are ordinarily available when you start | |
1535 | processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you can step and | |
1536 | continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the process | |
1537 | continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after | |
1538 | attaching _GDBN__ to the process. | |
1539 | ||
1540 | @table @code | |
1541 | @item detach | |
1542 | @kindex detach | |
1543 | When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the | |
1544 | @code{detach} command to release it from _GDBN__'s control. Detaching | |
1545 | the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command, | |
1546 | that process and _GDBN__ become completely independent once more, and you | |
1547 | are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}. | |
1548 | @code{detach} will not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after | |
1549 | executing the command. | |
1550 | @end table | |
1551 | ||
1552 | If you exit _GDBN__ or use the @code{run} command while you have an attached | |
1553 | process, you kill that process. By default, you will be asked for | |
1554 | confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can control | |
1555 | whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set confirm} command | |
1556 | (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}). | |
1557 | ||
1558 | @node Kill Process, , Attach, Running | |
1559 | @c @group | |
1560 | @section Killing the Child Process | |
1561 | ||
1562 | @table @code | |
1563 | @item kill | |
1564 | @kindex kill | |
1565 | Kill the child process in which your program is running under _GDBN__. | |
1566 | @end table | |
1567 | ||
1568 | This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a | |
1569 | running process. _GDBN__ ignores any core dump file while your program | |
1570 | is running. | |
1571 | @c @end group | |
1572 | ||
1573 | On some operating systems, a program can't be executed outside _GDBN__ | |
1574 | while you have breakpoints set on it inside _GDBN__. You can use the | |
1575 | @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running the program | |
1576 | outside the debugger. | |
1577 | ||
1578 | The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and | |
1579 | relink the program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an | |
1580 | executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you | |
1581 | next type @code{run}, _GDBN__ will notice that the file has changed, and | |
1582 | will re-read the symbol table (while trying to preserve your current | |
1583 | breakpoint settings). | |
1584 | ||
1585 | @node Stopping, Stack, Running, Top | |
1586 | @chapter Stopping and Continuing | |
1587 | ||
1588 | The principal purpose of using a debugger is so that you can stop your | |
1589 | program before it terminates; or so that, if the program runs into | |
1590 | trouble, you can investigate and find out why. | |
1591 | ||
1592 | Inside _GDBN__, your program may stop for any of several reasons, such | |
1593 | as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a _GDBN__ | |
1594 | command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and change | |
1595 | variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then continue | |
1596 | execution. Usually, the messages shown by _GDBN__ provide ample | |
1597 | explanation of the status of your program---but you can also explicitly | |
1598 | request this information at any time. | |
1599 | ||
1600 | @table @code | |
1601 | @item info program | |
1602 | @kindex info program | |
1603 | Display information about the status of your program: whether it is | |
1604 | running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped. | |
1605 | @end table | |
1606 | ||
1607 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
1608 | * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Exceptions |
1609 | * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming Execution | |
1610 | * Signals:: Signals | |
70b88761 RP |
1611 | @end menu |
1612 | ||
3d3ab540 | 1613 | @node Breakpoints, Continuing and Stepping, Stopping, Stopping |
70b88761 RP |
1614 | @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Exceptions |
1615 | ||
1616 | @cindex breakpoints | |
1617 | A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in | |
1618 | the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add various | |
1619 | conditions to control in finer detail whether the program will stop. | |
1620 | You can set breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants | |
1621 | (@pxref{Set Breaks}), to specify the place where the program should stop | |
1622 | by line number, function name or exact address in the program. In | |
1623 | languages with exception handling (such as GNU C++), you can also set | |
1624 | breakpoints where an exception is raised (@pxref{Exception Handling}). | |
1625 | ||
1626 | @cindex watchpoints | |
1627 | A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program when | |
1628 | the value of an expression changes. You must use a different command to | |
1629 | set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can | |
1630 | manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and | |
1631 | delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the same commands. | |
1632 | ||
1633 | Each breakpoint or watchpoint is assigned a number when it is created; | |
1634 | these numbers are successive integers starting with one. In many of the | |
1635 | commands for controlling various features of breakpoints you use the | |
1636 | breakpoint number to say which breakpoint you want to change. Each | |
1637 | breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has | |
1638 | no effect on the program until you enable it again. | |
1639 | ||
1640 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
1641 | * Set Breaks:: Setting Breakpoints |
1642 | * Set Watchpoints:: Setting Watchpoints | |
1643 | * Exception Handling:: Breakpoints and Exceptions | |
1644 | * Delete Breaks:: Deleting Breakpoints | |
1645 | * Disabling:: Disabling Breakpoints | |
1646 | * Conditions:: Break Conditions | |
1647 | * Break Commands:: Breakpoint Command Lists | |
1648 | * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint Menus | |
1649 | * Error in Breakpoints:: | |
70b88761 RP |
1650 | @end menu |
1651 | ||
1652 | @node Set Breaks, Set Watchpoints, Breakpoints, Breakpoints | |
1653 | @subsection Setting Breakpoints | |
1654 | ||
1655 | @kindex break | |
1656 | @kindex b | |
1657 | Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated @code{b}). | |
1658 | ||
1659 | You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go. | |
1660 | ||
1661 | @table @code | |
1662 | @item break @var{function} | |
1663 | Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}. When using source | |
1664 | languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as C++, | |
1665 | @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break. | |
1666 | @xref{Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation. | |
1667 | ||
1668 | @item break +@var{offset} | |
1669 | @itemx break -@var{offset} | |
1670 | Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position | |
1671 | at which execution stopped in the currently selected frame. | |
1672 | ||
1673 | @item break @var{linenum} | |
1674 | Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file. | |
1675 | That file is the last file whose source text was printed. This | |
1676 | breakpoint will stop the program just before it executes any of the | |
1677 | code on that line. | |
1678 | ||
1679 | @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum} | |
1680 | Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}. | |
1681 | ||
1682 | @item break @var{filename}:@var{function} | |
1683 | Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file | |
1684 | @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is | |
1685 | superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named | |
1686 | functions. | |
1687 | ||
1688 | @item break *@var{address} | |
1689 | Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set | |
1690 | breakpoints in parts of the program which do not have debugging | |
1691 | information or source files. | |
1692 | ||
1693 | @item break | |
1694 | When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at the | |
1695 | next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame | |
1696 | (@pxref{Stack}). In any selected frame but the innermost, this will | |
1697 | cause the program to stop as soon as control returns to that frame. | |
1698 | This is similar to the effect of a @code{finish} command in the frame | |
1699 | inside the selected frame---except that @code{finish} doesn't leave an | |
1700 | active breakpoint. If you use @code{break} without an argument in the | |
1701 | innermost frame, _GDBN__ will stop the next time it reaches the current | |
1702 | location; this may be useful inside loops. | |
1703 | ||
1704 | _GDBN__ normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at | |
1705 | least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you | |
1706 | would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the | |
1707 | breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already | |
1708 | existed when the program stopped. | |
1709 | ||
1710 | @item break @dots{} if @var{cond} | |
1711 | Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression | |
1712 | @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the | |
3d3ab540 RP |
1713 | value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true. |
1714 | @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described above | |
1715 | (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions}, for more | |
1716 | information on breakpoint conditions. | |
70b88761 RP |
1717 | |
1718 | @item tbreak @var{args} | |
1719 | @kindex tbreak | |
1720 | Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the | |
1721 | same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same | |
1722 | way, but the breakpoint is automatically disabled the first time it | |
1723 | is hit. @xref{Disabling}. | |
1724 | ||
1725 | @item rbreak @var{regex} | |
1726 | @kindex rbreak | |
1727 | @cindex regular expression | |
70b88761 | 1728 | Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression |
b80282d5 | 1729 | @var{regex}. This command |
70b88761 RP |
1730 | sets an unconditional breakpoint on all matches, printing a list of all |
1731 | breakpoints it set. Once these breakpoints are set, they are treated | |
1732 | just like the breakpoints set with the @code{break} command. They can | |
1733 | be deleted, disabled, made conditional, etc., in the standard ways. | |
1734 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
1735 | When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting |
1736 | breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special | |
1737 | classes. | |
1738 | ||
70b88761 | 1739 | @kindex info breakpoints |
c338a2fd | 1740 | @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints} |
70b88761 RP |
1741 | @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]} |
1742 | @item info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]} | |
1743 | Print a list of all breakpoints (but not watchpoints) set and not | |
1744 | deleted, showing their numbers, where in the program they are, and any | |
1745 | special features in use for them. Disabled breakpoints are included in | |
1746 | the list, but marked as disabled. @code{info break} with a breakpoint | |
1747 | number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The convenience | |
1748 | variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for the @code{x} | |
1749 | command are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed | |
1750 | (@pxref{Memory}). The equivalent command for watchpoints is @code{info | |
1751 | watch}. @end table | |
1752 | ||
1753 | _GDBN__ allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in the | |
1754 | program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When the | |
1755 | breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful (@pxref{Conditions}). | |
1756 | ||
1757 | @node Set Watchpoints, Exception Handling, Set Breaks, Breakpoints | |
1758 | @subsection Setting Watchpoints | |
1759 | @cindex setting watchpoints | |
1760 | You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an | |
1761 | expression changes, without having to predict a particular place | |
1762 | where this may happen. | |
1763 | ||
1764 | Watchpoints currently execute two orders of magnitude more slowly than | |
1765 | other breakpoints, but this can well be worth it to catch errors where | |
1766 | you have no clue what part of your program is the culprit. Some | |
1767 | processors provide special hardware to support watchpoint evaluation; future | |
1768 | releases of _GDBN__ will use such hardware if it is available. | |
1769 | ||
1770 | @table @code | |
1771 | @kindex watch | |
1772 | @item watch @var{expr} | |
1773 | Set a watchpoint for an expression. | |
1774 | ||
1775 | @kindex info watchpoints | |
1776 | @item info watchpoints | |
1777 | This command prints a list of watchpoints; it is otherwise similar to | |
1778 | @code{info break}. | |
1779 | @end table | |
1780 | ||
1781 | @node Exception Handling, Delete Breaks, Set Watchpoints, Breakpoints | |
1782 | @subsection Breakpoints and Exceptions | |
1783 | @cindex exception handlers | |
1784 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
1785 | Some languages, such as GNU C++, implement exception handling. You can |
1786 | use _GDBN__ to examine what caused the program to raise an exception, | |
70b88761 RP |
1787 | and to list the exceptions the program is prepared to handle at a |
1788 | given point in time. | |
1789 | ||
1790 | @table @code | |
1791 | @item catch @var{exceptions} | |
1792 | @kindex catch | |
1793 | You can set breakpoints at active exception handlers by using the | |
1794 | @code{catch} command. @var{exceptions} is a list of names of exceptions | |
1795 | to catch. | |
1796 | @end table | |
1797 | ||
1798 | You can use @code{info catch} to list active exception handlers; | |
1799 | @pxref{Frame Info}. | |
1800 | ||
1801 | There are currently some limitations to exception handling in _GDBN__. | |
1802 | These will be corrected in a future release. | |
1803 | ||
1804 | @itemize @bullet | |
1805 | @item | |
1806 | If you call a function interactively, _GDBN__ normally returns | |
1807 | control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call | |
1808 | raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that | |
1809 | returns control to the user and cause the program to simply continue | |
1810 | running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal that _GDBN__ is | |
1811 | listening for, or exits. | |
1812 | @item | |
1813 | You cannot raise an exception interactively. | |
1814 | @item | |
1815 | You cannot interactively install an exception handler. | |
1816 | @end itemize | |
1817 | ||
1818 | @cindex raise exceptions | |
1819 | Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling: | |
1820 | if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it's better to | |
1821 | stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you | |
1822 | can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a | |
1823 | breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find | |
1824 | out where the exception was raised. | |
1825 | ||
1826 | To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some | |
b80282d5 | 1827 | knowledge of the implementation. In the case of GNU C++, exceptions are |
70b88761 RP |
1828 | raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception} |
1829 | which has the following ANSI C interface: | |
1830 | ||
1831 | @example | |
b80282d5 | 1832 | /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored. |
70b88761 RP |
1833 | ID is the exception identifier. */ |
1834 | void __raise_exception (void **@var{addr}, void *@var{id}); | |
1835 | @end example | |
1836 | ||
1837 | @noindent | |
1838 | To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack | |
1839 | unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception} | |
1840 | (@pxref{Breakpoints}). | |
1841 | ||
1842 | With a conditional breakpoint (@xref{Conditions}) that depends on the | |
1843 | value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when a specific exception | |
1844 | is raised. You can use multiple conditional breakpoints to stop the | |
1845 | program when any of a number of exceptions are raised. | |
1846 | ||
1847 | @node Delete Breaks, Disabling, Exception Handling, Breakpoints | |
1848 | @subsection Deleting Breakpoints | |
1849 | ||
1850 | @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints | |
1851 | @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints | |
1852 | It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint or watchpoint once it | |
1853 | has done its job and you no longer want the program to stop there. This | |
1854 | is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A breakpoint that has been | |
1855 | deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten. | |
1856 | ||
1857 | With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to | |
1858 | where they are in the program. With the @code{delete} command you can | |
1859 | delete individual breakpoints or watchpoints by specifying their | |
1860 | breakpoint numbers. | |
1861 | ||
1862 | It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. _GDBN__ | |
1863 | automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed | |
1864 | when you continue execution without changing the execution address. | |
1865 | ||
1866 | @table @code | |
1867 | @item clear | |
1868 | @kindex clear | |
1869 | Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the | |
1870 | selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection}). When the innermost frame | |
1871 | is selected, this is a good way to delete a breakpoint that the program | |
1872 | just stopped at. | |
1873 | ||
1874 | @item clear @var{function} | |
1875 | @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function} | |
1876 | Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}. | |
1877 | ||
1878 | @item clear @var{linenum} | |
1879 | @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum} | |
1880 | Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line. | |
1881 | ||
1882 | @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]} | |
1883 | @cindex delete breakpoints | |
1884 | @kindex delete | |
1885 | @kindex d | |
1886 | Delete the breakpoints or watchpoints of the numbers specified as | |
1887 | arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all breakpoints (_GDBN__ | |
1888 | asks confirmation, unless you've @code{set confirm off}). You | |
1889 | can abbreviate this command as @code{d}. | |
1890 | @end table | |
1891 | ||
1892 | @node Disabling, Conditions, Delete Breaks, Breakpoints | |
1893 | @subsection Disabling Breakpoints | |
1894 | ||
1895 | @cindex disabled breakpoints | |
1896 | @cindex enabled breakpoints | |
1897 | Rather than deleting a breakpoint or watchpoint, you might prefer to | |
1898 | @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if it had | |
1899 | been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so that | |
1900 | you can @dfn{enable} it again later. | |
1901 | ||
1902 | You disable and enable breakpoints and watchpoints with the | |
1903 | @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one or | |
1904 | more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or | |
1905 | @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints or watchpoints if you | |
1906 | don't know which numbers to use. | |
1907 | ||
1908 | A breakpoint or watchpoint can have any of four different states of | |
1909 | enablement: | |
1910 | ||
1911 | @itemize @bullet | |
1912 | @item | |
1913 | Enabled. The breakpoint will stop the program. A breakpoint set | |
1914 | with the @code{break} command starts out in this state. | |
1915 | @item | |
1916 | Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on the program. | |
1917 | @item | |
1918 | Enabled once. The breakpoint will stop the program, but | |
1919 | when it does so it will become disabled. A breakpoint set | |
1920 | with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state. | |
1921 | @item | |
1922 | Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint will stop the program, but | |
1923 | immediately after it does so it will be deleted permanently. | |
1924 | @end itemize | |
1925 | ||
1926 | You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints and | |
1927 | watchpoints: | |
1928 | ||
1929 | @table @code | |
1930 | @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]} | |
1931 | @kindex disable breakpoints | |
1932 | @kindex disable | |
1933 | @kindex dis | |
1934 | Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are | |
1935 | listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All | |
1936 | options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in | |
1937 | case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate | |
1938 | @code{disable} as @code{dis}. | |
1939 | ||
1940 | @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]} | |
1941 | @kindex enable breakpoints | |
1942 | @kindex enable | |
1943 | Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They | |
1944 | become effective once again in stopping the program. | |
1945 | ||
1946 | @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{bnums}@dots{} | |
1947 | Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. Each will be disabled | |
1948 | again the next time it stops the program. | |
1949 | ||
1950 | @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{bnums}@dots{} | |
1951 | Enable the specified breakpoints to work once and then die. Each of | |
1952 | the breakpoints will be deleted the next time it stops the program. | |
1953 | @end table | |
1954 | ||
1955 | Save for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks}), | |
1956 | breakpoints that you set are initially enabled; subsequently, they become | |
1957 | disabled or enabled only when you use one of the commands above. (The | |
1958 | command @code{until} can set and delete a breakpoint of its own, but it | |
1959 | will not change the state of your other breakpoints; | |
3d3ab540 | 1960 | @pxref{Continuing and Stepping}.) |
70b88761 RP |
1961 | |
1962 | @node Conditions, Break Commands, Disabling, Breakpoints | |
1963 | @subsection Break Conditions | |
1964 | @cindex conditional breakpoints | |
1965 | @cindex breakpoint conditions | |
1966 | ||
1967 | The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time the program reaches a | |
1968 | specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a | |
1969 | breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
1970 | programming language. (@xref{Expressions}). A breakpoint with a condition |
1971 | evaluates the expression each time the program reaches it, and the | |
1972 | program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}. | |
3d3ab540 RP |
1973 | |
1974 | This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that | |
1975 | situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is, | |
1976 | when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed | |
1977 | by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition | |
1978 | @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint. | |
70b88761 RP |
1979 | |
1980 | Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them, | |
1981 | since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but | |
1982 | it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name, | |
1983 | and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting | |
1984 | one. | |
1985 | ||
1986 | Break conditions ca have side effects, and may even call functions in | |
1987 | your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions | |
1988 | that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to format | |
1989 | special data structures. The effects are completely predictable unless | |
1990 | there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In that | |
1991 | case, _GDBN__ might see the other breakpoint first and stop the program | |
1992 | without checking the condition of this one.) Note that breakpoint | |
1993 | commands are usually more convenient and flexible for the purpose of | |
1994 | performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached (@pxref{Break | |
1995 | Commands}). | |
1996 | ||
1997 | Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using | |
1998 | @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set Breaks}. | |
1999 | They can also be changed at any time with the @code{condition} command. | |
2000 | The @code{watch} command doesn't recognize the @code{if} keyword; | |
2001 | @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a | |
2002 | watchpoint. | |
2003 | ||
2004 | @table @code | |
2005 | @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression} | |
2006 | @kindex condition | |
2007 | Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint or | |
2008 | watchpoint number @var{bnum}. From now on, this breakpoint will stop | |
2009 | the program only if the value of @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in | |
2010 | C). When you use @code{condition}, _GDBN__ checks @var{expression} | |
2011 | immediately for syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols | |
2012 | in it have referents in the context of your breakpoint. _GDBN__ does | |
2013 | not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition} | |
2014 | command is given, however. @xref{Expressions}. | |
2015 | ||
2016 | @item condition @var{bnum} | |
2017 | Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes | |
2018 | an ordinary unconditional breakpoint. | |
2019 | @end table | |
2020 | ||
2021 | @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint) | |
2022 | A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the | |
2023 | breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so | |
2024 | useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore | |
2025 | count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which | |
2026 | is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and | |
2027 | therefore has no effect. But if the program reaches a breakpoint whose | |
2028 | ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements | |
2029 | the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count | |
2030 | value is @var{n}, the breakpoint will not stop the next @var{n} times it | |
2031 | is reached. | |
2032 | ||
2033 | @table @code | |
2034 | @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count} | |
2035 | @kindex ignore | |
2036 | Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}. | |
2037 | The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's | |
2038 | execution will not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, _GDBN__ | |
2039 | takes no action. | |
2040 | ||
2041 | To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify | |
2042 | a count of zero. | |
2043 | ||
2044 | @item continue @var{count} | |
2045 | @itemx c @var{count} | |
2046 | @itemx fg @var{count} | |
2047 | @kindex continue @var{count} | |
2048 | Continue execution of the program, setting the ignore count of the | |
2049 | breakpoint that the program stopped at to @var{count} minus one. | |
2050 | Thus, the program will not stop at this breakpoint until the | |
2051 | @var{count}'th time it is reached. | |
2052 | ||
2053 | An argument to this command is meaningful only when the program stopped | |
2054 | due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to @code{continue} is | |
2055 | ignored. | |
2056 | ||
2057 | The synonym @code{fg} is provided purely for convenience, and has | |
2058 | exactly the same behavior as other forms of the command. | |
2059 | @end table | |
2060 | ||
2061 | If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the condition | |
2062 | is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero, the condition will | |
2063 | be checked. | |
2064 | ||
2065 | You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a | |
2066 | condition such as _0__@w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}}_1__ using a debugger convenience | |
2067 | variable that is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars}. | |
2068 | ||
2069 | @node Break Commands, Breakpoint Menus, Conditions, Breakpoints | |
2070 | @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists | |
2071 | ||
2072 | @cindex breakpoint commands | |
2073 | You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint) a series of commands to | |
2074 | execute when the program stops due to that breakpoint. For example, you | |
2075 | might want to print the values of certain expressions, or enable other | |
2076 | breakpoints. | |
2077 | ||
2078 | @table @code | |
2079 | @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]} | |
2080 | @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{} | |
2081 | @itemx end | |
2082 | @kindex commands | |
2083 | @kindex end | |
2084 | Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands | |
2085 | themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just | |
2086 | @code{end} to terminate the commands. | |
2087 | ||
2088 | To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} followed | |
2089 | immediately by @code{end}; that is, give no commands. | |
2090 | ||
2091 | With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last | |
2092 | breakpoint or watchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently | |
2093 | encountered). | |
2094 | @end table | |
2095 | ||
2096 | Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last _GDBN__ command is | |
2097 | disabled within a @var{command-list}. | |
2098 | ||
2099 | You can use breakpoint commands to start the program up again. Simply | |
2100 | use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command | |
2101 | that resumes execution. Subsequent commands in the command list are | |
2102 | ignored. | |
2103 | ||
2104 | @kindex silent | |
2105 | If the first command specified is @code{silent}, the usual message about | |
2106 | stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may be desirable for | |
2107 | breakpoints that are to print a specific message and then continue. | |
2108 | If the remaining commands too print nothing, you will see no sign that | |
2109 | the breakpoint was reached at all. @code{silent} is meaningful only | |
2110 | at the beginning of a breakpoint command list. | |
2111 | ||
2112 | The commands @code{echo} and @code{output} that allow you to print precisely | |
2113 | controlled output are often useful in silent breakpoints. @xref{Output}. | |
2114 | ||
2115 | For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the | |
2116 | value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive. | |
2117 | ||
2118 | _0__@example | |
2119 | break foo if x>0 | |
2120 | commands | |
2121 | silent | |
2122 | echo x is\040 | |
2123 | output x | |
2124 | echo \n | |
2125 | cont | |
2126 | end | |
2127 | _1__@end example | |
2128 | ||
2129 | One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so | |
2130 | you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line | |
2131 | of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something | |
2132 | erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values | |
2133 | to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command | |
2134 | so that the program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent} | |
2135 | command so that no output is produced. Here is an example: | |
2136 | ||
2137 | @example | |
2138 | break 403 | |
2139 | commands | |
2140 | silent | |
2141 | set x = y + 4 | |
2142 | cont | |
2143 | end | |
2144 | @end example | |
2145 | ||
2146 | @cindex lost output | |
2147 | One deficiency in the operation of automatically continuing breakpoints | |
2148 | under Unix appears when your program uses raw mode for the terminal. | |
2149 | _GDBN__ switches back to its own terminal modes (not raw) before executing | |
2150 | commands, and then must switch back to raw mode when your program is | |
2151 | continued. This causes any pending terminal input to be lost. | |
2152 | @c FIXME: revisit below when GNU sys avail. | |
2153 | @c In the GNU system, this will be fixed by changing the behavior of | |
2154 | @c terminal modes. | |
2155 | ||
2156 | Under Unix, you can get around this problem by writing actions into | |
2157 | the breakpoint condition rather than in commands. For example | |
2158 | ||
2159 | @example | |
2160 | condition 5 (x = y + 4), 0 | |
2161 | @end example | |
2162 | ||
2163 | @noindent | |
2164 | specifies a condition expression (@xref{Expressions}) that will change | |
2165 | @code{x} as needed, then always have the value zero so the program will | |
2166 | not stop. No input is lost here, because _GDBN__ evaluates break | |
2167 | conditions without changing the terminal modes. When you want to have | |
2168 | nontrivial conditions for performing the side effects, the operators | |
2169 | @samp{&&}, @samp{||} and @samp{?@dots{}:} may be useful. | |
2170 | ||
2171 | @node Breakpoint Menus, Error in Breakpoints, Break Commands, Breakpoints | |
2172 | @subsection Breakpoint Menus | |
b80282d5 RP |
2173 | @cindex overloading |
2174 | @cindex symbol overloading | |
70b88761 RP |
2175 | |
2176 | Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name | |
2177 | to be defined several times, for application in different contexts. | |
2178 | This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded, | |
2179 | @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell _GDBN__ where you | |
2180 | want a breakpoint. _GDBN__ offers you a menu of numbered choices for | |
2181 | different possible breakpoints, and waits for your selection with the | |
2182 | prompt @samp{>}. The first two options are always @samp{[0] cancel} | |
2183 | and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1} sets a breakpoint at each | |
2184 | definition of @var{function}, and typing @kbd{0} aborts the | |
2185 | @code{break} command without setting any new breakpoints. | |
2186 | ||
2187 | For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a | |
2188 | breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}. | |
2189 | We choose three particular definitions of that function name: | |
2190 | ||
2191 | @example | |
2192 | (_GDBP__) b String::after | |
2193 | [0] cancel | |
2194 | [1] all | |
2195 | [2] file:String.cc; line number:867 | |
2196 | [3] file:String.cc; line number:860 | |
2197 | [4] file:String.cc; line number:875 | |
2198 | [5] file:String.cc; line number:853 | |
2199 | [6] file:String.cc; line number:846 | |
2200 | [7] file:String.cc; line number:735 | |
2201 | > 2 4 6 | |
2202 | Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867. | |
2203 | Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875. | |
2204 | Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846. | |
2205 | Multiple breakpoints were set. | |
2206 | Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted breakpoints. | |
2207 | (_GDBP__) | |
2208 | @end example | |
2209 | ||
2210 | ||
2211 | @node Error in Breakpoints, , Breakpoint Menus, Breakpoints | |
2212 | @subsection ``Cannot Insert Breakpoints'' | |
2213 | ||
2214 | @c FIXME: "cannot insert breakpoints" error, v unclear. | |
2215 | @c Q in pending mail to Gilmore. [email protected], 26mar91 | |
c338a2fd RP |
2216 | @c some light may be shed by looking at instances of |
2217 | @c ONE_PROCESS_WRITETEXT. But error seems possible otherwise | |
2218 | @c too. pesch, 20sep91 | |
70b88761 RP |
2219 | Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if |
2220 | any other process is running that program. In this situation, | |
2221 | attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes _GDBN__ | |
2222 | to stop the other process. | |
2223 | ||
2224 | When this happens, you have three ways to proceed: | |
2225 | ||
2226 | @enumerate | |
2227 | @item | |
2228 | Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue. | |
2229 | ||
2230 | @item | |
2231 | Suspend _GDBN__, and copy the file containing the program to a new name. | |
2232 | Resume _GDBN__ and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify that _GDBN__ | |
2233 | should run the program under that name. Then start the program again. | |
2234 | ||
2235 | @c FIXME: RMS commented here "Show example". Maybe when someone | |
2236 | @c explains the first FIXME: in this section... | |
2237 | ||
2238 | @item | |
2239 | Relink the program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the | |
2240 | linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply | |
2241 | to nonsharable executables. | |
2242 | @end enumerate | |
2243 | ||
3d3ab540 RP |
2244 | @node Continuing and Stepping, Signals, Breakpoints, Stopping |
2245 | @section Continuing and Stepping | |
70b88761 RP |
2246 | |
2247 | @cindex stepping | |
7463aadd RP |
2248 | @cindex continuing |
2249 | @cindex resuming execution | |
3d3ab540 RP |
2250 | @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program |
2251 | completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means resuming program | |
2252 | execution for a very limited time: one line of source code, or one | |
2253 | machine instruction. Either when continuing or when stepping, the | |
2254 | program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or to a signal. (If | |
2255 | due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use @samp{signal | |
2256 | 0} to resume execution; @pxref{Signals}.) | |
2257 | ||
2258 | @table @code | |
2259 | @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} | |
2260 | @kindex continue | |
2261 | Resume program execution, at the address where the program last stopped; | |
2262 | any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument | |
2263 | @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to | |
2264 | ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of | |
2265 | @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions}). | |
2266 | ||
2267 | To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return} | |
2268 | (@pxref{Returning}) to go back to the calling function; or @code{jump} | |
2269 | (@pxref{Jumping}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program. | |
2270 | ||
2271 | @end table | |
7463aadd RP |
2272 | |
2273 | A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint | |
70b88761 RP |
2274 | (@pxref{Breakpoints}) at the beginning of the function or the section of |
2275 | the program in which a problem is believed to lie, run the program until | |
2276 | it stops at that breakpoint, and then step through the suspect area, | |
2277 | examining the variables that are interesting, until you see the problem | |
2278 | happen. | |
2279 | ||
2280 | @table @code | |
2281 | @item step | |
2282 | @kindex step | |
2283 | @kindex s | |
2284 | Continue running the program until control reaches a different source | |
7463aadd | 2285 | line, then stop it and return control to _GDBN__. This command is |
70b88761 RP |
2286 | abbreviated @code{s}. |
2287 | ||
3d3ab540 RP |
2288 | @quotation |
2289 | @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is | |
2290 | within a function that was compiled without debugging information, | |
2291 | execution will proceed until control reaches another function. | |
2292 | @end quotation | |
70b88761 RP |
2293 | |
2294 | @item step @var{count} | |
2295 | Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a | |
2296 | breakpoint is reached or a signal not related to stepping occurs before | |
2297 | @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away. | |
2298 | ||
7463aadd | 2299 | @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} |
70b88761 RP |
2300 | @kindex next |
2301 | @kindex n | |
7463aadd RP |
2302 | Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame. |
2303 | Similar to @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the line | |
2304 | of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when control | |
2305 | reaches a different line of code at the stack level which was executing | |
2306 | when the @code{next} command was given. This command is abbreviated | |
2307 | @code{n}. | |
70b88761 | 2308 | |
7463aadd | 2309 | An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}. |
70b88761 RP |
2310 | |
2311 | @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like | |
2312 | @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the | |
2313 | function are executed without stopping. | |
2314 | ||
2315 | @item finish | |
2316 | @kindex finish | |
7463aadd RP |
2317 | Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame |
2318 | returns. Print the returned value (if any). | |
70b88761 RP |
2319 | |
2320 | Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning}). | |
2321 | ||
2322 | @item until | |
2323 | @kindex until | |
2324 | @item u | |
2325 | @kindex u | |
2326 | Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the | |
2327 | current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single | |
2328 | stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next} | |
2329 | command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it | |
2330 | automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater | |
2331 | than the address of the jump. | |
2332 | ||
2333 | This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping | |
2334 | though it, @code{until} will cause the program to continue execution | |
2335 | until the loop is exited. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end | |
2336 | of a loop will simply step back to the beginning of the loop, which | |
2337 | would force you to step through the next iteration. | |
2338 | ||
2339 | @code{until} always stops the program if it attempts to exit the current | |
2340 | stack frame. | |
2341 | ||
2342 | @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order | |
7463aadd | 2343 | of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For |
70b88761 RP |
2344 | example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f} |
2345 | (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line | |
2346 | @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}: | |
2347 | ||
2348 | @example | |
2349 | (_GDBP__) f | |
2350 | #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206 | |
b80282d5 | 2351 | 206 expand_input(); |
70b88761 | 2352 | (_GDBP__) until |
b80282d5 | 2353 | 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{ |
70b88761 RP |
2354 | @end example |
2355 | ||
7463aadd RP |
2356 | This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had |
2357 | generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the | |
2358 | start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is | |
2359 | written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared | |
2360 | to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this | |
2361 | expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier | |
2362 | statement---not in terms of the actual machine code. | |
70b88761 RP |
2363 | |
2364 | @code{until} with no argument works by means of single | |
2365 | instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an | |
2366 | argument. | |
2367 | ||
2368 | @item until @var{location} | |
2369 | @item u @var{location} | |
2370 | Continue running the program until either the specified location is | |
7463aadd | 2371 | reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} |
70b88761 RP |
2372 | is any of the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set |
2373 | Breaks}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and hence is | |
2374 | quicker than @code{until} without an argument. | |
2375 | ||
2376 | @item stepi | |
2377 | @itemx si | |
2378 | @kindex stepi | |
2379 | @kindex si | |
2380 | Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger. | |
2381 | ||
2382 | It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine | |
2383 | instructions. This will cause the next instruction to be executed to | |
2384 | be displayed automatically at each stop. @xref{Auto Display}. | |
2385 | ||
2386 | An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}. | |
2387 | ||
2388 | @item nexti | |
2389 | @itemx ni | |
2390 | @kindex nexti | |
2391 | @kindex ni | |
2392 | Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call, | |
2393 | proceed until the function returns. | |
2394 | ||
2395 | An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}. | |
70b88761 RP |
2396 | @end table |
2397 | ||
70b88761 | 2398 | |
3d3ab540 | 2399 | @node Signals, , Continuing and Stepping, Stopping |
70b88761 RP |
2400 | @section Signals |
2401 | @cindex signals | |
2402 | ||
2403 | A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The | |
2404 | operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each | |
2405 | kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the | |
2406 | signal a program gets when you type an interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}); | |
2407 | @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in | |
2408 | memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when | |
2409 | the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if the program has | |
2410 | requested an alarm). | |
2411 | ||
2412 | @cindex fatal signals | |
2413 | Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the | |
2414 | functioning of the program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate | |
2415 | errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (kill the program immediately) if the | |
2416 | program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal. | |
2417 | @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in the program, but it is normally | |
2418 | fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program. | |
2419 | ||
2420 | _GDBN__ has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in the program | |
2421 | running under _GDBN__'s control. You can tell _GDBN__ in advance what to do for | |
2422 | each kind of signal. | |
2423 | ||
2424 | @cindex handling signals | |
2425 | Normally, _GDBN__ is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM} | |
2426 | (so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of the program) | |
2427 | but to stop the program immediately whenever an error signal happens. | |
2428 | You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command. | |
2429 | ||
2430 | @table @code | |
2431 | @item info signals | |
2432 | @kindex info signals | |
2433 | Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how _GDBN__ has been told to | |
2434 | handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all | |
2435 | the defined types of signals. | |
2436 | ||
2437 | @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{} | |
2438 | @kindex handle | |
2439 | Change the way _GDBN__ handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the | |
2440 | number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the | |
2441 | beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make. | |
2442 | @end table | |
2443 | ||
2444 | @c @group | |
2445 | The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated. | |
2446 | Their full names are: | |
2447 | ||
2448 | @table @code | |
2449 | @item nostop | |
2450 | _GDBN__ should not stop the program when this signal happens. It may | |
2451 | still print a message telling you that the signal has come in. | |
2452 | ||
2453 | @item stop | |
2454 | _GDBN__ should stop the program when this signal happens. This implies | |
2455 | the @code{print} keyword as well. | |
2456 | ||
2457 | @item print | |
2458 | _GDBN__ should print a message when this signal happens. | |
2459 | ||
2460 | @item noprint | |
2461 | _GDBN__ should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This | |
2462 | implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well. | |
2463 | ||
2464 | @item pass | |
2465 | _GDBN__ should allow the program to see this signal; the program will be | |
2466 | able to handle the signal, or may be terminated if the signal is fatal | |
2467 | and not handled. | |
2468 | ||
2469 | @item nopass | |
2470 | _GDBN__ should not allow the program to see this signal. | |
2471 | @end table | |
2472 | @c @end group | |
2473 | ||
2474 | When a signal has been set to stop the program, the program cannot see the | |
2475 | signal until you continue. It will see the signal then, if @code{pass} is | |
2476 | in effect for the signal in question @i{at that time}. In other words, | |
2477 | after _GDBN__ reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle} command with | |
2478 | @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether that signal will be seen by | |
2479 | the program when you later continue it. | |
2480 | ||
2481 | You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent the program from | |
2482 | seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see, | |
7463aadd RP |
2483 | or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if the program stopped |
2484 | due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct | |
2485 | values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more | |
2486 | execution; but the program would probably terminate immediately as | |
2487 | a result of the fatal signal once it sees the signal. To prevent this, | |
2488 | you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling}. | |
70b88761 RP |
2489 | |
2490 | @node Stack, Source, Stopping, Top | |
2491 | @chapter Examining the Stack | |
2492 | ||
2493 | When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it | |
2494 | stopped and how it got there. | |
2495 | ||
2496 | @cindex call stack | |
2497 | Each time your program performs a function call, the information about | |
2498 | where in the program the call was made from is saved in a block of data | |
2499 | called a @dfn{stack frame}. The frame also contains the arguments of the | |
2500 | call and the local variables of the function that was called. All the | |
2501 | stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call | |
2502 | stack}. | |
2503 | ||
2504 | When your program stops, the _GDBN__ commands for examining the stack allow you | |
2505 | to see all of this information. | |
2506 | ||
2507 | @cindex selected frame | |
2508 | One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by _GDBN__ and many _GDBN__ commands | |
2509 | refer implicitly to the selected frame. In particular, whenever you ask | |
2510 | _GDBN__ for the value of a variable in the program, the value is found in the | |
2511 | selected frame. There are special _GDBN__ commands to select whichever frame | |
2512 | you are interested in. | |
2513 | ||
2514 | When the program stops, _GDBN__ automatically selects the currently executing | |
2515 | frame and describes it briefly as the @code{frame} command does | |
2516 | (@pxref{Frame Info, Info}). | |
2517 | ||
2518 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
2519 | * Frames:: Stack Frames |
2520 | * Backtrace:: Backtraces | |
2521 | * Selection:: Selecting a Frame | |
2522 | * Frame Info:: Information on a Frame | |
70b88761 RP |
2523 | @end menu |
2524 | ||
2525 | @node Frames, Backtrace, Stack, Stack | |
2526 | @section Stack Frames | |
2527 | ||
2528 | @cindex frame | |
2529 | @cindex stack frame | |
2530 | The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack | |
2531 | frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated | |
2532 | with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given | |
2533 | to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at | |
2534 | which the function is executing. | |
2535 | ||
2536 | @cindex initial frame | |
2537 | @cindex outermost frame | |
2538 | @cindex innermost frame | |
2539 | When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the | |
2540 | function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the | |
2541 | @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is | |
2542 | made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation | |
2543 | is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for | |
2544 | the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is | |
2545 | actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most | |
2546 | recently created of all the stack frames that still exist. | |
2547 | ||
2548 | @cindex frame pointer | |
2549 | Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A | |
2550 | stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each | |
2551 | kind of computer has a convention for choosing one of those bytes whose | |
2552 | address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept | |
2553 | in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is | |
2554 | going on in that frame. | |
2555 | ||
2556 | @cindex frame number | |
2557 | _GDBN__ assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with | |
2558 | zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it, | |
2559 | and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program; | |
2560 | they are assigned by _GDBN__ to give you a way of designating stack | |
2561 | frames in _GDBN__ commands. | |
2562 | ||
2563 | @cindex frameless execution | |
2564 | Some compilers allow functions to be compiled so that they operate | |
2565 | without stack frames. (For example, the @code{_GCC__} option | |
2566 | @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} will generate functions without a frame.) | |
2567 | This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save | |
2568 | the frame setup time. _GDBN__ has limited facilities for dealing with | |
2569 | these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation has no | |
2570 | stack frame, _GDBN__ will nevertheless regard it as though it had a | |
2571 | separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing correct | |
2572 | tracing of the function call chain. However, _GDBN__ has no provision | |
2573 | for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack. | |
2574 | ||
2575 | @node Backtrace, Selection, Frames, Stack | |
2576 | @section Backtraces | |
2577 | ||
2578 | A backtrace is a summary of how the program got where it is. It shows one | |
2579 | line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing | |
2580 | frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the | |
2581 | stack. | |
2582 | ||
2583 | @table @code | |
2584 | @item backtrace | |
2585 | @itemx bt | |
2586 | @kindex backtrace | |
2587 | @kindex bt | |
2588 | Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all | |
2589 | frames in the stack. | |
2590 | ||
2591 | You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt | |
2592 | character, normally @kbd{C-c}. | |
2593 | ||
2594 | @item backtrace @var{n} | |
2595 | @itemx bt @var{n} | |
2596 | Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames. | |
2597 | ||
2598 | @item backtrace -@var{n} | |
2599 | @itemx bt -@var{n} | |
2600 | Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames. | |
2601 | @end table | |
2602 | ||
2603 | @kindex where | |
2604 | @kindex info stack | |
2605 | @kindex info s | |
2606 | The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s}) | |
2607 | are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}. | |
2608 | ||
2609 | Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name. | |
2610 | The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set | |
2611 | print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and | |
2612 | line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program | |
2613 | counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that | |
2614 | line number. | |
2615 | ||
2616 | Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command | |
2617 | @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames. | |
2618 | ||
2619 | @smallexample | |
2620 | @group | |
2621 | #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8) at builtin.c:993 | |
2622 | #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242 | |
2623 | #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08) | |
2624 | at macro.c:71 | |
2625 | (More stack frames follow...) | |
2626 | @end group | |
2627 | @end smallexample | |
2628 | ||
2629 | @noindent | |
2630 | The display for frame zero doesn't begin with a program counter | |
2631 | value, indicating that the program has stopped at the beginning of the | |
2632 | code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}. | |
2633 | ||
2634 | @node Selection, Frame Info, Backtrace, Stack | |
2635 | @section Selecting a Frame | |
2636 | ||
2637 | Most commands for examining the stack and other data in the program work on | |
2638 | whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for | |
2639 | selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description | |
2640 | of the stack frame just selected. | |
2641 | ||
2642 | @table @code | |
2643 | @item frame @var{n} | |
2644 | @itemx f @var{n} | |
2645 | @kindex frame | |
2646 | @kindex f | |
2647 | Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost | |
2648 | (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the | |
2649 | innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is @code{main}'s | |
2650 | frame. | |
2651 | ||
2652 | @item frame @var{addr} | |
2653 | @itemx f @var{addr} | |
2654 | Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the | |
2655 | chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it | |
2656 | impossible for _GDBN__ to assign numbers properly to all frames. In | |
2657 | addition, this can be useful when the program has multiple stacks and | |
2658 | switches between them. | |
2659 | ||
2660 | _if_(_SPARC__) | |
2661 | On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to | |
2662 | select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer. | |
2663 | @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag | |
2664 | @c FRAME_SPECIFICATION_DYADIC in the tm-*.h files, currently only used | |
2665 | @c by SPARC, hence the specific attribution. Generalize or list all | |
2666 | @c possibilities if more supported machines start doing this. | |
2667 | _fi_(_SPARC__) | |
2668 | ||
2669 | @item up @var{n} | |
2670 | @kindex up | |
2671 | Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this | |
2672 | advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames | |
2673 | that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one. | |
2674 | ||
2675 | @item down @var{n} | |
2676 | @kindex down | |
2677 | @kindex do | |
2678 | Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this | |
2679 | advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames | |
2680 | that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may | |
2681 | abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}. | |
2682 | @end table | |
2683 | ||
2684 | All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the | |
2685 | frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the | |
2686 | arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that | |
2687 | frame. The second line shows the text of that source line. For | |
2688 | example: | |
2689 | ||
2690 | @smallexample | |
2691 | (_GDBP__) up | |
2692 | #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc) at env.c:10 | |
2693 | 10 read_input_file (argv[i]); | |
2694 | @end smallexample | |
2695 | ||
2696 | After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments will print | |
2697 | ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame. @xref{List}. | |
2698 | ||
2699 | @table @code | |
2700 | @item up-silently @var{n} | |
2701 | @itemx down-silently @var{n} | |
2702 | @kindex down-silently | |
2703 | @kindex up-silently | |
2704 | These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down}, | |
2705 | respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without | |
2706 | causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use | |
2707 | in _GDBN__ command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and | |
2708 | distracting. | |
2709 | ||
2710 | @end table | |
2711 | ||
2712 | @node Frame Info, , Selection, Stack | |
2713 | @section Information About a Frame | |
2714 | ||
2715 | There are several other commands to print information about the selected | |
2716 | stack frame. | |
2717 | ||
2718 | @table @code | |
2719 | @item frame | |
2720 | @itemx f | |
2721 | When used without any argument, this command does not change which frame | |
2722 | is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently | |
2723 | selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an | |
2724 | argument, this command is used to select a stack frame (@pxref{Selection}). | |
2725 | ||
2726 | @item info frame | |
2727 | @kindex info frame | |
2728 | @itemx info f | |
2729 | @kindex info f | |
2730 | This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame, | |
2731 | including the address of the frame, the addresses of the next frame down | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
2732 | (called by this frame) and the next frame up (caller of this frame), the |
2733 | language that the source code corresponding to this frame was written in, | |
70b88761 RP |
2734 | the address of the frame's arguments, the program counter saved in it |
2735 | (the address of execution in the caller frame), and which registers | |
2736 | were saved in the frame. The verbose description is useful when | |
2737 | something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit | |
2738 | the usual conventions. | |
2739 | ||
2740 | @item info frame @var{addr} | |
2741 | @itemx info f @var{addr} | |
2742 | Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, | |
2743 | without selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by | |
2744 | this command. | |
2745 | ||
2746 | @item info args | |
2747 | @kindex info args | |
2748 | Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line. | |
2749 | ||
2750 | @item info locals | |
2751 | @kindex info locals | |
2752 | Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate | |
2753 | line. These are all variables declared static or automatic within all | |
2754 | program blocks that execution in this frame is currently inside of. | |
2755 | ||
2756 | @item info catch | |
2757 | @kindex info catch | |
2758 | @cindex catch exceptions | |
2759 | @cindex exception handlers | |
2760 | Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the | |
2761 | current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other | |
2762 | exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up}, | |
2763 | @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}. | |
2764 | @xref{Exception Handling}. | |
2765 | @end table | |
2766 | ||
2767 | @node Source, Data, Stack, Top | |
2768 | @chapter Examining Source Files | |
2769 | ||
2770 | _GDBN__ can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging | |
2771 | information recorded in your program tells _GDBN__ what source files | |
2772 | were used to built it. When your program stops, _GDBN__ spontaneously | |
2773 | prints the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack | |
2774 | frame (@pxref{Selection}), _GDBN__ prints the line where execution in | |
2775 | that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of source files by | |
2776 | explicit command. | |
2777 | ||
2778 | If you use _GDBN__ through its GNU Emacs interface, you may prefer to | |
2779 | use Emacs facilities to view source; @pxref{Emacs}. | |
2780 | ||
2781 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
2782 | * List:: Printing Source Lines |
2783 | * Search:: Searching Source Files | |
2784 | * Source Path:: Specifying Source Directories | |
2785 | * Machine Code:: Source and Machine Code | |
70b88761 RP |
2786 | @end menu |
2787 | ||
2788 | @node List, Search, Source, Source | |
2789 | @section Printing Source Lines | |
2790 | ||
2791 | @kindex list | |
2792 | @kindex l | |
2793 | To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command | |
2794 | (abbreviated @code{l}). There are several ways to specify what part | |
2795 | of the file you want to print. | |
2796 | ||
2797 | Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used: | |
2798 | ||
2799 | @table @code | |
2800 | @item list @var{linenum} | |
c338a2fd | 2801 | Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the |
70b88761 RP |
2802 | current source file. |
2803 | ||
2804 | @item list @var{function} | |
c338a2fd | 2805 | Print lines centered around the beginning of function |
70b88761 RP |
2806 | @var{function}. |
2807 | ||
2808 | @item list | |
c338a2fd RP |
2809 | Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a |
2810 | @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines | |
70b88761 | 2811 | printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed |
c338a2fd | 2812 | as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack}), this prints |
70b88761 RP |
2813 | lines centered around that line. |
2814 | ||
2815 | @item list - | |
c338a2fd RP |
2816 | Print lines just before the lines last printed. |
2817 | @end table | |
2818 | ||
2819 | By default, _GDBN__ prints ten source lines with any of these forms of | |
2820 | the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}: | |
2821 | ||
2822 | @table @code | |
2823 | @item set listsize @var{count} | |
2824 | @kindex set listsize | |
2825 | Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless | |
2826 | the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number). | |
2827 | ||
2828 | @item show listsize | |
2829 | @kindex show listsize | |
2830 | Display the number of lines that @code{list} will currently display by | |
2831 | default. | |
70b88761 RP |
2832 | @end table |
2833 | ||
2834 | Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument, | |
2835 | so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful | |
2836 | than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an | |
2837 | argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that | |
2838 | each repetition moves up in the source file. | |
2839 | ||
2840 | @cindex linespec | |
2841 | In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two | |
2842 | @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways | |
2843 | of writing them but the effect is always to specify some source line. | |
2844 | Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}: | |
2845 | ||
2846 | @table @code | |
2847 | @item list @var{linespec} | |
c338a2fd | 2848 | Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}. |
70b88761 RP |
2849 | |
2850 | @item list @var{first},@var{last} | |
2851 | Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are | |
2852 | linespecs. | |
2853 | ||
2854 | @item list ,@var{last} | |
c338a2fd | 2855 | Print lines ending with @var{last}. |
70b88761 RP |
2856 | |
2857 | @item list @var{first}, | |
c338a2fd | 2858 | Print lines starting with @var{first}. |
70b88761 RP |
2859 | |
2860 | @item list + | |
c338a2fd | 2861 | Print lines just after the lines last printed. |
70b88761 RP |
2862 | |
2863 | @item list - | |
c338a2fd | 2864 | Print lines just before the lines last printed. |
70b88761 RP |
2865 | |
2866 | @item list | |
2867 | As described in the preceding table. | |
2868 | @end table | |
2869 | ||
2870 | Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the | |
2871 | kinds of linespec. | |
2872 | ||
2873 | @table @code | |
2874 | @item @var{number} | |
2875 | Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file. | |
2876 | When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to | |
2877 | the same source file as the first linespec. | |
2878 | ||
2879 | @item +@var{offset} | |
2880 | Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed. | |
2881 | When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has | |
2882 | two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the | |
2883 | first linespec. | |
2884 | ||
2885 | @item -@var{offset} | |
2886 | Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed. | |
2887 | ||
2888 | @item @var{filename}:@var{number} | |
2889 | Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}. | |
2890 | ||
2891 | @item @var{function} | |
2892 | @c FIXME: "of the open-brace" is C-centric. When we add other langs... | |
2893 | Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the | |
2894 | function @var{function}. | |
2895 | ||
2896 | @item @var{filename}:@var{function} | |
2897 | Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the | |
2898 | function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the | |
2899 | file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are | |
2900 | identically named functions in different source files. | |
2901 | ||
2902 | @item *@var{address} | |
2903 | Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}. | |
2904 | @var{address} may be any expression. | |
2905 | @end table | |
2906 | ||
2907 | @node Search, Source Path, List, Source | |
2908 | @section Searching Source Files | |
2909 | @cindex searching | |
2910 | @kindex reverse-search | |
2911 | ||
2912 | There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a | |
2913 | regular expression. | |
2914 | ||
2915 | @table @code | |
2916 | @item forward-search @var{regexp} | |
2917 | @itemx search @var{regexp} | |
2918 | @kindex search | |
2919 | @kindex forward-search | |
2920 | The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting | |
2921 | with the one following the last line listed, for a match for @var{regexp}. | |
2922 | It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate the command name | |
2923 | as @code{fo}. The synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} is also supported. | |
2924 | ||
2925 | @item reverse-search @var{regexp} | |
2926 | The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting | |
2927 | with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match | |
2928 | for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate | |
2929 | this command as @code{rev}. | |
2930 | @end table | |
2931 | ||
2932 | @node Source Path, Machine Code, Search, Source | |
2933 | @section Specifying Source Directories | |
2934 | ||
2935 | @cindex source path | |
2936 | @cindex directories for source files | |
2937 | Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source | |
2938 | files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do, | |
2939 | the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging | |
2940 | session. _GDBN__ has a list of directories to search for source files; | |
2941 | this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time _GDBN__ wants a source file, | |
2942 | it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present | |
2943 | in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that | |
2944 | the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is | |
2945 | the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source | |
2946 | path. | |
2947 | ||
2948 | If _GDBN__ can't find a source file in the source path, and the object | |
2949 | program records a directory, _GDBN__ tries that directory too. If the | |
2950 | source path is empty, and there is no record of the compilation | |
2951 | directory, _GDBN__ will, as a last resort, look in the current | |
2952 | directory. | |
2953 | ||
2954 | Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, _GDBN__ will clear out | |
2955 | any information it has cached about where source files are found, where | |
2956 | each line is in the file, etc. | |
2957 | ||
2958 | @kindex directory | |
2959 | When you start _GDBN__, its source path is empty. | |
2960 | To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command. | |
2961 | ||
2962 | @table @code | |
2963 | @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{} | |
2964 | Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several | |
2965 | directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:} or | |
2966 | whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source | |
7463aadd RP |
2967 | path; this moves it forward, so it will be searched sooner. |
2968 | ||
2969 | You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation | |
2970 | directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current | |
2971 | working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former | |
2972 | tracks the current working directory as it changes during your _GDBN__ | |
2973 | session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current | |
2974 | directory at the time you add an entry to the source path. | |
70b88761 RP |
2975 | |
2976 | @item directory | |
2977 | Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation. | |
2978 | ||
2979 | @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since | |
2980 | @c repeating it would be a no-op we don't say that. (thanks to RMS) | |
2981 | ||
2982 | @item show directories | |
2983 | @kindex show directories | |
2984 | Print the source path: show which directories it contains. | |
2985 | @end table | |
2986 | ||
2987 | If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of | |
2988 | interest, _GDBN__ may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong | |
2989 | versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows: | |
2990 | ||
2991 | @enumerate | |
2992 | @item | |
2993 | Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty. | |
2994 | ||
2995 | @item | |
2996 | Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the | |
2997 | directories you want in the source path. You can add all the | |
2998 | directories in one command. | |
2999 | @end enumerate | |
3000 | ||
3001 | @node Machine Code, , Source Path, Source | |
3002 | @section Source and Machine Code | |
3003 | You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program | |
3004 | addresses (and viceversa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display | |
3005 | a range of addresses as machine instructions. | |
3006 | ||
3007 | @table @code | |
3008 | @item info line @var{linespec} | |
3009 | @kindex info line | |
3010 | Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for | |
3011 | source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of the | |
3012 | ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List}). | |
3013 | @end table | |
3014 | ||
3015 | For example, we can use @code{info line} to inquire on where the object | |
3016 | code for the first line of function @code{m4_changequote} lies: | |
3017 | @smallexample | |
3018 | (_GDBP__) info line m4_changecom | |
3019 | Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350. | |
3020 | @end smallexample | |
3021 | ||
3022 | @noindent | |
3023 | We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for | |
3024 | @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address: | |
3025 | @smallexample | |
3026 | (_GDBP__) info line *0x63ff | |
3027 | Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404. | |
3028 | @end smallexample | |
3029 | ||
c338a2fd | 3030 | @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line} |
70b88761 RP |
3031 | After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} |
3032 | command is changed to the starting address of the line, so that | |
3033 | @samp{x/i} is sufficient to begin examining the machine code | |
3034 | (@pxref{Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the | |
3035 | convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars}). | |
3036 | ||
3037 | @table @code | |
3038 | @kindex disassemble | |
3039 | @item disassemble | |
3040 | This specialized command is provided to dump a range of memory as | |
3041 | machine instructions. The default memory range is the function | |
3042 | surrounding the program counter of the selected frame. A single | |
3043 | argument to this command is a program counter value; the function | |
3044 | surrounding this value will be dumped. Two arguments (separated by one | |
3045 | or more spaces) specify a range of addresses (first inclusive, second | |
3046 | exclusive) to be dumped. | |
3047 | @end table | |
3048 | ||
3049 | We can use @code{disassemble} to inspect the object code | |
3050 | range shown in the last @code{info line} example: | |
3051 | ||
3052 | @smallexample | |
3053 | (_GDBP__) disas 0x63e4 0x6404 | |
3054 | Dump of assembler code from 0x63e4 to 0x6404: | |
b80282d5 RP |
3055 | 0x63e4 <builtin_init+5340>: ble 0x63f8 <builtin_init+5360> |
3056 | 0x63e8 <builtin_init+5344>: sethi %hi(0x4c00), %o0 | |
3057 | 0x63ec <builtin_init+5348>: ld [%i1+4], %o0 | |
3058 | 0x63f0 <builtin_init+5352>: b 0x63fc <builtin_init+5364> | |
3059 | 0x63f4 <builtin_init+5356>: ld [%o0+4], %o0 | |
3060 | 0x63f8 <builtin_init+5360>: or %o0, 0x1a4, %o0 | |
3061 | 0x63fc <builtin_init+5364>: call 0x9288 <path_search> | |
3062 | 0x6400 <builtin_init+5368>: nop | |
70b88761 RP |
3063 | End of assembler dump. |
3064 | (_GDBP__) | |
3065 | ||
3066 | @end smallexample | |
3067 | ||
c2bbbb22 | 3068 | @node Data, Languages, Source, Top |
70b88761 RP |
3069 | @chapter Examining Data |
3070 | ||
3071 | @cindex printing data | |
3072 | @cindex examining data | |
3073 | @kindex print | |
3074 | @kindex inspect | |
3075 | @c "inspect" isn't quite a synonym if you're using Epoch, which we don't | |
3076 | @c document because it's nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a | |
3077 | @c different window or something like that. | |
3078 | The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print} | |
3079 | command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It | |
b80282d5 | 3080 | evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your |
c2bbbb22 | 3081 | program is written in (@pxref{Languages}). You type |
70b88761 RP |
3082 | |
3083 | @example | |
3084 | print @var{exp} | |
3085 | @end example | |
3086 | ||
3087 | @noindent | |
b80282d5 | 3088 | where @var{exp} is an expression (in the source language), and |
70b88761 RP |
3089 | the value of @var{exp} is printed in a format appropriate to its data |
3090 | type. | |
3091 | ||
3092 | A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command. | |
3093 | It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a | |
3094 | specified format. @xref{Memory}. | |
3095 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
3096 | If you're interested in information about types, or about how the fields |
3097 | of a struct or class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}} | |
3098 | command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols}. | |
3099 | ||
70b88761 | 3100 | @menu |
b80282d5 RP |
3101 | * Expressions:: Expressions |
3102 | * Variables:: Program Variables | |
3103 | * Arrays:: Artificial Arrays | |
3104 | * Output formats:: Output formats | |
3105 | * Memory:: Examining Memory | |
3106 | * Auto Display:: Automatic Display | |
3107 | * Print Settings:: Print Settings | |
3108 | * Value History:: Value History | |
3109 | * Convenience Vars:: Convenience Variables | |
3110 | * Registers:: Registers | |
3111 | * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating Point Hardware | |
70b88761 RP |
3112 | @end menu |
3113 | ||
3114 | @node Expressions, Variables, Data, Data | |
3115 | @section Expressions | |
3116 | ||
3117 | @cindex expressions | |
3118 | @code{print} and many other _GDBN__ commands accept an expression and | |
3119 | compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined | |
3120 | by the programming language you are using is legal in an expression in | |
3121 | _GDBN__. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts | |
3122 | and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined | |
b80282d5 | 3123 | by preprocessor @code{#define} commands. |
70b88761 | 3124 | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
3125 | Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in |
3126 | this manual are in C. @xref{Languages,, Using _GDBN__ with Different | |
3127 | Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other | |
3128 | languages. | |
3129 | ||
3130 | In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in _GDBN__ | |
3131 | expressions regardless of your programming language. | |
3132 | ||
70b88761 RP |
3133 | Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so |
3134 | useful to cast a number into a pointer so as to examine a structure | |
3135 | at that address in memory. | |
c2bbbb22 | 3136 | @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true? |
70b88761 | 3137 | |
c2bbbb22 | 3138 | _GDBN__ supports these operators in addition to those of programming |
70b88761 RP |
3139 | languages: |
3140 | ||
3141 | @table @code | |
3142 | @item @@ | |
3143 | @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays. | |
3144 | @xref{Arrays}, for more information. | |
3145 | ||
3146 | @item :: | |
3147 | @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or | |
3148 | function where it is defined. @xref{Variables}. | |
3149 | ||
3150 | @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr} | |
3151 | Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in | |
3152 | memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or | |
3153 | pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in | |
3154 | a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is | |
3155 | normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.@refill | |
3156 | @end table | |
3157 | ||
3158 | @node Variables, Arrays, Expressions, Data | |
3159 | @section Program Variables | |
3160 | ||
3161 | The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable | |
3162 | in your program. | |
3163 | ||
3164 | Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame | |
3165 | (@pxref{Selection}); they must either be global (or static) or be visible | |
3166 | according to the scope rules of the programming language from the point of | |
3167 | execution in that frame. This means that in the function | |
3168 | ||
3169 | @example | |
3170 | foo (a) | |
3171 | int a; | |
3172 | @{ | |
3173 | bar (a); | |
3174 | @{ | |
3175 | int b = test (); | |
3176 | bar (b); | |
3177 | @} | |
3178 | @} | |
3179 | @end example | |
3180 | ||
3181 | @noindent | |
3182 | the variable @code{a} is usable whenever the program is executing | |
3183 | within the function @code{foo}, but the variable @code{b} is visible | |
3184 | only while the program is executing inside the block in which @code{b} | |
3185 | is declared. | |
3186 | ||
3187 | @cindex variable name conflict | |
3188 | There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose | |
3189 | scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not | |
3190 | in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or | |
3191 | function with the same name (in different source files). If that happens, | |
3192 | referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish, you can | |
3193 | specify a variable in a particular file, using the colon-colon notation: | |
3194 | ||
3195 | @cindex colon-colon | |
3196 | @kindex :: | |
3197 | @example | |
3198 | @var{file}::@var{variable} | |
3199 | @end example | |
3200 | ||
3201 | @noindent | |
3202 | Here @var{file} is the name of the source file whose variable you want. | |
3203 | ||
c2bbbb22 | 3204 | @cindex C++ scope resolution |
70b88761 RP |
3205 | This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar |
3206 | use of the same notation in C++. _GDBN__ also supports use of the C++ | |
c2bbbb22 | 3207 | scope resolution operator in _GDBN__ expressions. |
70b88761 | 3208 | |
3d3ab540 RP |
3209 | @cindex wrong values |
3210 | @cindex variable values, wrong | |
3211 | @quotation | |
3212 | @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the | |
3213 | wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to the | |
3214 | function, and just before exit. You may see this problem when you're | |
3215 | stepping by machine instructions. This is because on most machines, it | |
3216 | takes more than one instruction to set up a stack frame (including local | |
3217 | variable definitions); if you're stepping by machine instructions, | |
3218 | variables may appear to have the wrong values until the stack frame is | |
3219 | completely built. On function exit, it usually also takes more than one | |
3220 | machine instruction to destroy a stack frame; after you begin stepping | |
3221 | through that group of instructions, local variable definitions may be | |
3222 | gone. | |
3223 | @end quotation | |
3224 | ||
70b88761 RP |
3225 | @node Arrays, Output formats, Variables, Data |
3226 | @section Artificial Arrays | |
3227 | ||
3228 | @cindex artificial array | |
3229 | @kindex @@ | |
3230 | It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the | |
3231 | same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of | |
3232 | dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the | |
3233 | program. | |
3234 | ||
3235 | This can be done by constructing an @dfn{artificial array} with the | |
3236 | binary operator @samp{@@}. The left operand of @samp{@@} should be | |
3237 | the first element of the desired array, as an individual object. | |
3238 | The right operand should be the desired length of the array. The result is | |
3239 | an array value whose elements are all of the type of the left argument. | |
3240 | The first element is actually the left argument; the second element | |
3241 | comes from bytes of memory immediately following those that hold the | |
3242 | first element, and so on. Here is an example. If a program says | |
3243 | ||
3244 | @example | |
3245 | int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int)); | |
3246 | @end example | |
3247 | ||
3248 | @noindent | |
3249 | you can print the contents of @code{array} with | |
3250 | ||
3251 | @example | |
3252 | p *array@@len | |
3253 | @end example | |
3254 | ||
3255 | The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made | |
3256 | with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of | |
3257 | subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions. | |
3258 | Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history | |
3259 | (@pxref{Value History}), after printing one out.) | |
3260 | ||
3d3ab540 RP |
3261 | Sometimes the artificial array mechanism isn't quite enough; in |
3262 | moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not | |
3263 | actually be adjacent---for example, if you're interested in the values | |
3264 | of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is to | |
3265 | use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a counter in an | |
3266 | expression that prints the first interesting value, and then repeat that | |
3267 | expression via @key{RET}. For instance, suppose you have an array | |
3268 | @code{dtab} of pointers to structures, and you're interested in the | |
3269 | values of a field @code{fv} in each structure. Here's an example of | |
3270 | what you might type: | |
3271 | @example | |
3272 | set $i = 0 | |
3273 | p dtab[$i++]->fv | |
3274 | @key{RET} | |
3275 | @key{RET} | |
3276 | @dots{} | |
3277 | @end example | |
3278 | ||
70b88761 RP |
3279 | @node Output formats, Memory, Arrays, Data |
3280 | @section Output formats | |
3281 | ||
3282 | @cindex formatted output | |
3283 | @cindex output formats | |
3284 | By default, _GDBN__ prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes | |
3285 | this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number | |
3286 | in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory | |
3287 | at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do | |
3288 | these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value. | |
3289 | ||
3290 | The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value | |
3291 | already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the | |
3292 | @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format | |
3293 | letters supported are: | |
3294 | ||
3295 | @table @code | |
3296 | @item x | |
3297 | Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in | |
3298 | hexadecimal. | |
3299 | ||
3300 | @item d | |
3301 | Print as integer in signed decimal. | |
3302 | ||
3303 | @item u | |
3304 | Print as integer in unsigned decimal. | |
3305 | ||
3306 | @item o | |
3307 | Print as integer in octal. | |
3308 | ||
3309 | @item t | |
3310 | Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''. | |
3311 | ||
3312 | @item a | |
3313 | Print as an address, both absolute in hex and as an offset from the | |
3314 | nearest preceding symbol. This format can be used to discover where (in | |
3315 | what function) an unknown address is located: | |
3316 | @example | |
3317 | (_GDBP__) p/a 0x54320 | |
3318 | _0__$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>_1__ | |
3319 | @end example | |
3320 | ||
3321 | ||
3322 | @item c | |
3323 | Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. | |
3324 | ||
3325 | @item f | |
3326 | Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print | |
3327 | using typical floating point syntax. | |
3328 | @end table | |
3329 | ||
3330 | For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type | |
3331 | ||
3332 | @example | |
3333 | p/x $pc | |
3334 | @end example | |
3335 | ||
3336 | @noindent | |
3337 | Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command | |
3338 | names in _GDBN__ cannot contain a slash. | |
3339 | ||
3340 | To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format, | |
3341 | you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no | |
3342 | expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex. | |
3343 | ||
3344 | @node Memory, Auto Display, Output formats, Data | |
3345 | @section Examining Memory | |
3346 | ||
3347 | @cindex examining memory | |
3348 | @table @code | |
3349 | @kindex x | |
3350 | @item x/@var{nfu} @var{expr} | |
3351 | The command @code{x} (for `examine') can be used to examine memory | |
3352 | without being constrained by your program's data types. You can specify | |
3353 | the unit size @var{u} of memory to inspect, and a repeat count @var{n} of how | |
3354 | many of those units to display. @code{x} understands the formats | |
3355 | @var{f} used by @code{print}; two additional formats, @samp{s} (string) | |
3356 | and @samp{i} (machine instruction) can be used without specifying a unit | |
3357 | size. | |
3358 | @end table | |
3359 | ||
3360 | For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords | |
3361 | (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}), | |
3362 | starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four | |
3363 | words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp}; | |
3364 | @pxref{Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}). | |
3365 | ||
3366 | Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the | |
3367 | letters specifying output formats, you don't have to remember whether | |
3368 | unit size or format comes first; either order will work. The output | |
3369 | specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing. | |
3370 | ||
3371 | After the format specification, you supply an expression for the address | |
3372 | where _GDBN__ is to begin reading from memory. The expression need not | |
3373 | have a pointer value (though it may); it is always interpreted as an | |
3374 | integer address of a byte of memory. @xref{Expressions} for more | |
3375 | information on expressions. | |
3376 | ||
3377 | These are the memory units @var{u} you can specify with the @code{x} | |
3378 | command: | |
3379 | ||
3380 | @table @code | |
3381 | @item b | |
3382 | Examine individual bytes. | |
3383 | ||
3384 | @item h | |
3385 | Examine halfwords (two bytes each). | |
3386 | ||
3387 | @item w | |
3388 | Examine words (four bytes each). | |
3389 | ||
3390 | @cindex word | |
3391 | Many assemblers and cpu designers still use `word' for a 16-bit quantity, | |
3392 | as a holdover from specific predecessor machines of the 1970's that really | |
3393 | did use two-byte words. But more generally the term `word' has always | |
3394 | referred to the size of quantity that a machine normally operates on and | |
3395 | stores in its registers. This is 32 bits for all the machines that _GDBN__ | |
3396 | runs on. | |
3397 | ||
3398 | @item g | |
3399 | Examine giant words (8 bytes). | |
3400 | @end table | |
3401 | ||
3402 | You can combine these unit specifications with any of the formats | |
3403 | described for @code{print}. @xref{Output formats}. | |
3404 | ||
3405 | @code{x} has two additional output specifications which derive the unit | |
3406 | size from the data inspected: | |
3407 | ||
3408 | @table @code | |
3409 | @item s | |
3410 | Print a null-terminated string of characters. Any explicitly specified | |
3411 | unit size is ignored; instead, the unit is however many bytes it takes | |
3412 | to reach a null character (including the null character). | |
3413 | ||
3414 | @item i | |
3415 | Print a machine instruction in assembler syntax (or nearly). Any | |
3416 | specified unit size is ignored; the number of bytes in an instruction | |
3417 | varies depending on the type of machine, the opcode and the addressing | |
3418 | modes used. The command @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of | |
3419 | inspecting machine instructions. @xref{Machine Code}. | |
3420 | @end table | |
3421 | ||
3422 | If you omit either the format @var{f} or the unit size @var{u}, @code{x} | |
3423 | will use the same one that was used last. If you don't use any letters | |
3424 | or digits after the slash, you can omit the slash as well. | |
3425 | ||
3426 | You can also omit the address to examine. Then the address used is just | |
3427 | after the last unit examined. This is why string and instruction | |
3428 | formats actually compute a unit-size based on the data: so that the next | |
3429 | string or instruction examined will start in the right place. | |
3430 | ||
3431 | When the @code{print} command shows a value that resides in memory, | |
3432 | @code{print} also sets the default address for the @code{x} command. | |
3433 | @code{info line} also sets the default for @code{x}, to the address of | |
3434 | the start of the machine code for the specified line (@pxref{Machine | |
3435 | Code}), and @code{info breakpoints} sets it to the address of the last | |
3436 | breakpoint listed (@pxref{Set Breaks}). | |
3437 | ||
3438 | When you use @key{RET} to repeat an @code{x} command, the address | |
3439 | specified previously (if any) is ignored, so that the repeated command | |
3440 | examines the successive locations in memory rather than the same ones. | |
3441 | ||
3442 | You can examine several consecutive units of memory with one command by | |
3443 | writing a repeat-count after the slash (before the format letters, if | |
3444 | any). Omitting the repeat count @var{n} displays one unit of the | |
3445 | appropriate size. The repeat count must be a decimal integer. It has | |
3446 | the same effect as repeating the @code{x} command @var{n} times except | |
3447 | that the output may be more compact, with several units per line. For | |
3448 | example, | |
3449 | ||
3450 | @example | |
3451 | x/10i $pc | |
3452 | @end example | |
3453 | ||
3454 | @noindent | |
3455 | prints ten instructions starting with the one to be executed next in the | |
3456 | selected frame. After doing this, you could print a further seven | |
3457 | instructions with | |
3458 | ||
3459 | @example | |
3460 | x/7 | |
3461 | @end example | |
3462 | ||
3463 | @noindent | |
3464 | ---where the format and address are allowed to default. | |
3465 | ||
c338a2fd | 3466 | @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history |
70b88761 RP |
3467 | The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not put |
3468 | in the value history because there is often too much of them and they | |
3469 | would get in the way. Instead, _GDBN__ makes these values available for | |
3470 | subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables | |
3471 | @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address | |
3472 | examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable | |
3473 | @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in | |
3474 | the convenience variable @code{$__}. | |
3475 | ||
3476 | If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved | |
3477 | are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last | |
3478 | address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output. | |
3479 | ||
3480 | @node Auto Display, Print Settings, Memory, Data | |
3481 | @section Automatic Display | |
3482 | @cindex automatic display | |
3483 | @cindex display of expressions | |
3484 | ||
3485 | If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently | |
3486 | (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic | |
3487 | display list} so that _GDBN__ will print its value each time the program stops. | |
3488 | Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it; | |
3489 | to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number. | |
3490 | The automatic display looks like this: | |
3491 | ||
3492 | @example | |
3493 | 2: foo = 38 | |
3494 | 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804 | |
3495 | @end example | |
3496 | ||
3497 | @noindent | |
3498 | showing item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with | |
3499 | displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can | |
3500 | specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides | |
3501 | whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your | |
3502 | format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size, | |
3503 | or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only | |
3504 | supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}. | |
3505 | ||
3506 | @table @code | |
3507 | @item display @var{exp} | |
3508 | @kindex display | |
3509 | Add the expression @var{exp} to the list of expressions to display | |
3510 | each time the program stops. @xref{Expressions}. | |
3511 | ||
3512 | @code{display} will not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it. | |
3513 | ||
3514 | @item display/@var{fmt} @var{exp} | |
3515 | For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or | |
3516 | count, add the expression @var{exp} to the auto-display list but | |
3517 | arranges to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}. | |
3518 | @xref{Output formats}. | |
3519 | ||
3520 | @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr} | |
3521 | For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a | |
3522 | number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to | |
3523 | be examined each time the program stops. Examining means in effect | |
3524 | doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory}. | |
3525 | @end table | |
3526 | ||
3527 | For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine | |
3528 | instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc} | |
3529 | is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers}). | |
3530 | ||
3531 | @table @code | |
3532 | @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{} | |
3533 | @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{} | |
3534 | @kindex delete display | |
3535 | @kindex undisplay | |
3536 | Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display. | |
3537 | ||
3538 | @code{undisplay} will not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. | |
3539 | (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.) | |
3540 | ||
3541 | @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{} | |
3542 | @kindex disable display | |
3543 | Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display | |
3544 | item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be | |
3545 | enabled again later. | |
3546 | ||
3547 | @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{} | |
3548 | @kindex enable display | |
3549 | Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once | |
3550 | again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise. | |
3551 | ||
3552 | @item display | |
3553 | Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is | |
3554 | done when the program stops. | |
3555 | ||
3556 | @item info display | |
3557 | @kindex info display | |
3558 | Print the list of expressions previously set up to display | |
3559 | automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the | |
3560 | values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such. | |
3561 | It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now | |
3562 | because they refer to automatic variables not currently available. | |
3563 | @end table | |
3564 | ||
3565 | If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make | |
3566 | sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an | |
3567 | expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its | |
3568 | variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command | |
3569 | @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument | |
3570 | @code{last_char}, then this argument will be displayed while the program | |
3571 | continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where | |
3572 | there is no variable @code{last_char}---display is disabled. The next time | |
3573 | your program stops where @code{last_char} is meaningful, you can enable the | |
3574 | display expression once again. | |
3575 | ||
3576 | @node Print Settings, Value History, Auto Display, Data | |
3577 | @section Print Settings | |
3578 | ||
3579 | @cindex format options | |
3580 | @cindex print settings | |
3581 | _GDBN__ provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures, | |
3582 | and symbols are printed. | |
3583 | ||
3584 | @noindent | |
3585 | These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language: | |
3586 | ||
3587 | @table @code | |
3588 | @item set print address | |
3589 | @item set print address on | |
3590 | @kindex set print address | |
3591 | _GDBN__ will print memory addresses showing the location of stack | |
3592 | traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth, | |
3593 | even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default | |
3594 | is on. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like, with | |
3595 | @code{set print address on}: | |
3596 | @smallexample | |
3597 | (_GDBP__) f | |
3598 | #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>") | |
3599 | at input.c:530 | |
b80282d5 | 3600 | 530 if (lquote != def_lquote) |
70b88761 RP |
3601 | @end smallexample |
3602 | ||
3603 | @item set print address off | |
3604 | Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example, | |
3605 | this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}: | |
3606 | @example | |
3607 | (_GDBP__) set print addr off | |
3608 | (_GDBP__) f | |
3609 | #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530 | |
b80282d5 | 3610 | 530 if (lquote != def_lquote) |
70b88761 RP |
3611 | @end example |
3612 | ||
3613 | @item show print address | |
3614 | @kindex show print address | |
3615 | Show whether or not addresses are to be printed. | |
3616 | ||
3617 | @item set print array | |
3618 | @itemx set print array on | |
3619 | @kindex set print array | |
3620 | _GDBN__ will pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read, | |
3621 | but uses more space. The default is off. | |
3622 | ||
3623 | @item set print array off. | |
3624 | Return to compressed format for arrays. | |
3625 | ||
3626 | @item show print array | |
3627 | @kindex show print array | |
3628 | Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying | |
3629 | arrays. | |
3630 | ||
3631 | @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements} | |
3632 | @kindex set print elements | |
3633 | If _GDBN__ is printing a large array, it will stop printing after it has | |
3634 | printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command. | |
3635 | This limit also applies to the display of strings. | |
3636 | ||
3637 | @item show print elements | |
3638 | @kindex show print elements | |
3639 | Display the number of elements of a large array that _GDBN__ will print | |
3640 | before losing patience. | |
3641 | ||
3642 | @item set print pretty on | |
3643 | @kindex set print pretty | |
3644 | Cause _GDBN__ to print structures in an indented format with one member per | |
3645 | line, like this: | |
3646 | ||
3647 | @example | |
3648 | $1 = @{ | |
3649 | next = 0x0, | |
3650 | flags = @{ | |
3651 | sweet = 1, | |
3652 | sour = 1 | |
3653 | @}, | |
3654 | meat = 0x54 "Pork" | |
3655 | @} | |
3656 | @end example | |
3657 | ||
3658 | @item set print pretty off | |
3659 | Cause _GDBN__ to print structures in a compact format, like this: | |
3660 | ||
3661 | @smallexample | |
3662 | $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, meat \ | |
3663 | = 0x54 "Pork"@} | |
3664 | @end smallexample | |
3665 | ||
3666 | @noindent | |
3667 | This is the default format. | |
3668 | ||
3669 | @item show print pretty | |
3670 | @kindex show print pretty | |
3671 | Show which format _GDBN__ will use to print structures. | |
3672 | ||
3673 | @item set print sevenbit-strings on | |
f2857bd9 | 3674 | @kindex set print sevenbit-strings |
70b88761 RP |
3675 | Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set, |
3676 | _GDBN__ will display any eight-bit characters (in strings or character | |
3677 | values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. For example, @kbd{M-a} is | |
3678 | displayed as @code{\341}. | |
3679 | ||
3680 | @item set print sevenbit-strings off | |
3681 | Print using either seven-bit or eight-bit characters, as required. This | |
3682 | is the default. | |
3683 | ||
3684 | @item show print sevenbit-strings | |
f2857bd9 | 3685 | @kindex show print sevenbit-strings |
70b88761 RP |
3686 | Show whether or not _GDBN__ will print only seven-bit characters. |
3687 | ||
3688 | @item set print union on | |
3689 | @kindex set print union | |
3690 | Tell _GDBN__ to print unions which are contained in structures. This is the | |
3691 | default setting. | |
3692 | ||
3693 | @item set print union off | |
3694 | Tell _GDBN__ not to print unions which are contained in structures. | |
3695 | ||
3696 | @item show print union | |
3697 | @kindex show print union | |
3698 | Ask _GDBN__ whether or not it will print unions which are contained in | |
3699 | structures. | |
3700 | ||
3701 | For example, given the declarations | |
3702 | ||
3703 | @smallexample | |
3704 | typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species; | |
3705 | typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms; | |
3706 | typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@} Bug_forms; | |
3707 | ||
3708 | struct thing @{ | |
3709 | Species it; | |
3710 | union @{ | |
3711 | Tree_forms tree; | |
3712 | Bug_forms bug; | |
3713 | @} form; | |
3714 | @}; | |
3715 | ||
3716 | struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@}; | |
3717 | @end smallexample | |
3718 | ||
3719 | @noindent | |
3720 | with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print | |
3721 | ||
3722 | @smallexample | |
3723 | $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@} | |
3724 | @end smallexample | |
3725 | ||
3726 | @noindent | |
3727 | and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print | |
3728 | ||
3729 | @smallexample | |
3730 | $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@} | |
3731 | @end smallexample | |
3732 | @end table | |
3733 | ||
3734 | @noindent | |
3735 | These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs: | |
3736 | ||
3737 | @table @code | |
3738 | @item set print demangle | |
3739 | @itemx set print demangle on | |
3740 | @kindex set print demangle | |
3741 | Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the mangled form | |
3742 | in which they are passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe linkage. | |
3743 | The default is on. | |
3744 | ||
3745 | @item show print demangle | |
3746 | @kindex show print demangle | |
3747 | Show whether C++ names will be printed in mangled or demangled form. | |
3748 | ||
3749 | @item set print asm-demangle | |
3750 | @itemx set print asm-demangle on | |
3751 | @kindex set print asm-demangle | |
3752 | Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even | |
3753 | in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies. | |
3754 | The default is off. | |
3755 | ||
3756 | @item show print asm-demangle | |
3757 | @kindex show print asm-demangle | |
3758 | Show whether C++ names in assembly listings will be printed in mangled | |
3759 | or demangled form. | |
3760 | ||
3761 | @item set print object | |
3762 | @itemx set print object on | |
3763 | @kindex set print object | |
3764 | When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual} | |
3765 | (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using | |
3766 | the virtual function table. | |
3767 | ||
3768 | @item set print object off | |
3769 | Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the | |
3770 | virtual function table. This is the default setting. | |
3771 | ||
3772 | @item show print object | |
3773 | @kindex show print object | |
3774 | Show whether actual, or declared, object types will be displayed. | |
3775 | ||
3776 | @item set print vtbl | |
3777 | @itemx set print vtbl on | |
3778 | @kindex set print vtbl | |
3779 | Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off. | |
3780 | ||
3781 | @item set print vtbl off | |
3782 | Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables. | |
3783 | ||
3784 | @item show print vtbl | |
3785 | @kindex show print vtbl | |
3786 | Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not. | |
3787 | ||
3788 | @end table | |
3789 | ||
3790 | @node Value History, Convenience Vars, Print Settings, Data | |
3791 | @section Value History | |
3792 | ||
3793 | @cindex value history | |
3794 | Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in _GDBN__'s @dfn{value | |
3795 | history} so that you can refer to them in other expressions. Values are | |
3796 | kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded (for example with | |
3797 | the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands). When the symbol table | |
3798 | changes, the value history is discarded, since the values may contain | |
3799 | pointers back to the types defined in the symbol table. | |
3800 | ||
3801 | @cindex @code{$} | |
3802 | @cindex @code{$$} | |
3803 | @cindex history number | |
3804 | The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} for you to refer to them | |
3805 | by. These are successive integers starting with one. @code{print} shows you | |
3806 | the history number assigned to a value by printing @samp{$@var{num} = } | |
3807 | before the value; here @var{num} is the history number. | |
3808 | ||
3809 | To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's | |
3810 | history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to | |
3811 | remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in | |
3812 | the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that. | |
3813 | @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2} | |
3814 | is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to | |
3815 | @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}. | |
3816 | ||
3817 | For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and | |
3818 | want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type | |
3819 | ||
3820 | @example | |
3821 | p *$ | |
3822 | @end example | |
3823 | ||
3824 | If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points | |
3825 | to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this: | |
3826 | ||
3827 | @example | |
3828 | p *$.next | |
3829 | @end example | |
3830 | ||
3831 | @noindent | |
3832 | You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this | |
3833 | command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}. | |
3834 | ||
3835 | Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of | |
3836 | @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands: | |
3837 | ||
3838 | @example | |
3839 | print x | |
3840 | set x=5 | |
3841 | @end example | |
3842 | ||
3843 | @noindent | |
3844 | then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command | |
3845 | remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed. | |
3846 | ||
3847 | @table @code | |
3848 | @kindex show values | |
3849 | @item show values | |
3850 | Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers. | |
3851 | This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show | |
3852 | values} does not change the history. | |
3853 | ||
3854 | @item show values @var{n} | |
3855 | Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}. | |
3856 | ||
3857 | @item show values + | |
3858 | Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more | |
3859 | values are available, produces no display. | |
3860 | @end table | |
3861 | ||
3862 | Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the | |
3863 | same effect as @samp{show values +}. | |
3864 | ||
3865 | @node Convenience Vars, Registers, Value History, Data | |
3866 | @section Convenience Variables | |
3867 | ||
3868 | @cindex convenience variables | |
3869 | _GDBN__ provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within | |
3870 | _GDBN__ to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables | |
3871 | exist entirely within _GDBN__; they are not part of your program, and | |
3872 | setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution | |
3873 | of your program. That's why you can use them freely. | |
3874 | ||
3875 | Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by | |
3876 | @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of | |
3877 | the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers}). | |
3878 | (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded | |
3879 | by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History}.) | |
3880 | ||
3881 | You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment | |
3882 | expression, just as you would set a variable in your program. Example: | |
3883 | ||
3884 | @example | |
3885 | set $foo = *object_ptr | |
3886 | @end example | |
3887 | ||
3888 | @noindent | |
3889 | would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by | |
3890 | @code{object_ptr}. | |
3891 | ||
3892 | Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it; but its value | |
3893 | is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the value with | |
3894 | another assignment at any time. | |
3895 | ||
3896 | Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience | |
3897 | variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if | |
3898 | that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience | |
3899 | variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value. | |
3900 | ||
3901 | @table @code | |
3902 | @item show convenience | |
3903 | @kindex show convenience | |
3904 | Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values. | |
3905 | Abbreviated @code{show con}. | |
3906 | @end table | |
3907 | ||
3908 | One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be | |
3909 | incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print | |
3910 | a field from successive elements of an array of structures: | |
3911 | ||
3912 | _0__@example | |
3913 | set $i = 0 | |
3914 | print bar[$i++]->contents | |
3915 | @i{@dots{} repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.} | |
3916 | _1__@end example | |
3917 | ||
3918 | Some convenience variables are created automatically by _GDBN__ and given | |
3919 | values likely to be useful. | |
3920 | ||
3921 | @table @code | |
3922 | @item $_ | |
c338a2fd | 3923 | @kindex $_ |
70b88761 RP |
3924 | The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to |
3925 | the last address examined (@pxref{Memory}). Other commands which | |
3926 | provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also set @code{$_} | |
3927 | to that address; these commands include @code{info line} and @code{info | |
c338a2fd | 3928 | breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *} except when set by the |
c2bbbb22 | 3929 | @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer to the type of @code{$__}. |
70b88761 RP |
3930 | |
3931 | @item $__ | |
c338a2fd | 3932 | @kindex $__ |
70b88761 | 3933 | The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command |
c2bbbb22 RP |
3934 | to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen |
3935 | to match the format in which the data was printed. | |
70b88761 RP |
3936 | @end table |
3937 | ||
3938 | @node Registers, Floating Point Hardware, Convenience Vars, Data | |
3939 | @section Registers | |
3940 | ||
3941 | @cindex registers | |
b80282d5 | 3942 | You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables |
70b88761 RP |
3943 | with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different |
3944 | for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on | |
3945 | your machine. | |
3946 | ||
3947 | @table @code | |
3948 | @item info registers | |
3949 | @kindex info registers | |
b80282d5 RP |
3950 | Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point |
3951 | registers (in the selected stack frame). | |
3952 | ||
3953 | @item info all-registers | |
3954 | @kindex info all-registers | |
3955 | @cindex floating point registers | |
3956 | Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point | |
3957 | registers. | |
70b88761 RP |
3958 | |
3959 | @item info registers @var{regname} | |
3960 | Print the relativized value of register @var{regname}. @var{regname} | |
3961 | may be any register name valid on the machine you are using, with | |
3962 | or without the initial @samp{$}. | |
3963 | @end table | |
3964 | ||
3965 | The register names @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used on most machines | |
3966 | for the program counter register and the stack pointer. For example, | |
3967 | you could print the program counter in hex with | |
3968 | @example | |
3969 | p/x $pc | |
3970 | @end example | |
3971 | ||
3972 | @noindent | |
3973 | or print the instruction to be executed next with | |
3974 | @example | |
3975 | x/i $pc | |
3976 | @end example | |
3977 | ||
3978 | @noindent | |
3979 | or add four to the stack pointer with | |
3980 | @example | |
3981 | set $sp += 4 | |
3982 | @end example | |
3983 | ||
3984 | @noindent | |
3985 | The last is a way of removing one word from the stack, on machines where | |
3986 | stacks grow downward in memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes | |
3987 | that the innermost stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is | |
3988 | not allowed when other stack frames are selected. (To pop entire frames | |
3989 | off the stack, regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return}; | |
3990 | @pxref{Returning}.) | |
3991 | ||
3992 | Often @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a pointer to the | |
3993 | current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is sometimes used for a register | |
3994 | that contains the processor status. These standard register names may | |
3995 | be available on your machine even though the @code{info registers} | |
3996 | command shows other names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info | |
3997 | registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you | |
3998 | can also refer to it as @code{$ps}. | |
3999 | ||
4000 | _GDBN__ always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an | |
4001 | integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have | |
4002 | special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these | |
4003 | registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way | |
4004 | to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value | |
4005 | (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with | |
4006 | @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}). | |
4007 | ||
4008 | Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This | |
4009 | means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by | |
4010 | the operating system is not the same one that your program normally | |
4011 | sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point | |
4012 | coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C | |
4013 | programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such | |
4014 | cases, _GDBN__ normally works with the virtual format only (the format that | |
4015 | makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command | |
4016 | prints the data in both formats. | |
4017 | ||
4018 | Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame | |
4019 | (@pxref{Selection}). This means that you get the value that the | |
4020 | register would contain if all stack frames farther in were exited and | |
4021 | their saved registers restored. In order to see the true contents of | |
4022 | hardware registers, you must select the innermost frame (with | |
4023 | @samp{frame 0}). | |
4024 | ||
4025 | However, _GDBN__ must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine | |
4026 | code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if | |
4027 | _GDBN__ is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack | |
4028 | frame will make no difference. | |
4029 | ||
4030 | @node Floating Point Hardware, , Registers, Data | |
4031 | @section Floating Point Hardware | |
4032 | @cindex floating point | |
4033 | Depending on the host machine architecture, _GDBN__ may be able to give | |
4034 | you more information about the status of the floating point hardware. | |
4035 | ||
4036 | @table @code | |
4037 | @item info float | |
4038 | @kindex info float | |
4039 | If available, provides hardware-dependent information about the floating | |
4040 | point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the | |
4041 | floating point chip. | |
4042 | @end table | |
4043 | @c FIXME: this is a cop-out. Try to get examples, explanations. Only | |
4044 | @c FIXME...supported currently on arm's and 386's. Mark properly with | |
4045 | @c FIXME... m4 macros to isolate general statements from hardware-dep, | |
4046 | @c FIXME... at that point. | |
4047 | ||
c2bbbb22 RP |
4048 | @node Languages, Symbols, Data, Top |
4049 | @chapter Using _GDBN__ with Different Languages | |
4050 | @cindex languages | |
4051 | ||
4052 | Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are | |
4053 | rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C, | |
4054 | dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in | |
4055 | Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be | |
4056 | represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C are written | |
4057 | like @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}. | |
4058 | ||
4059 | @cindex working language | |
4060 | Language-specific information is built into _GDBN__ for some languages, | |
4061 | allowing you to express operations like the above in the program's | |
4062 | native language, and allowing _GDBN__ to output values in a manner | |
4063 | consistent with the syntax of the program's native language. The | |
4064 | language you use to build expressions, called the @dfn{working | |
4065 | language}, can be selected manually, or _GDBN__ can set it | |
4066 | automatically. | |
4067 | ||
4068 | @menu | |
4069 | * Setting:: Switching between source languages | |
4070 | * Show:: Displaying the language | |
4071 | * Checks:: Type and Range checks | |
4072 | * Support:: Supported languages | |
4073 | @end menu | |
4074 | ||
4075 | @node Setting, Show, Languages, Languages | |
4076 | @section Switching between source languages | |
4077 | ||
4078 | There are two ways to control the working language---either have _GDBN__ | |
4079 | set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the | |
4080 | @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, _GDBN__ | |
4081 | defaults to setting the language automatically. | |
4082 | ||
4083 | @menu | |
4084 | * Manually:: Setting the working language manually | |
4085 | * Automatically:: Having _GDBN__ infer the source language | |
4086 | @end menu | |
4087 | ||
4088 | @node Manually, Automatically, Setting, Setting | |
4089 | @subsection Setting the working language | |
4090 | ||
4091 | @kindex set language | |
4092 | To set the language, issue the command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, | |
c338a2fd RP |
4093 | where @var{lang} is the name of a language: @code{c} or @code{modula-2}. |
4094 | For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}. | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
4095 | |
4096 | Setting the language manually prevents _GDBN__ from updating the working | |
4097 | language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try | |
4098 | to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the | |
4099 | source language, when an expression is acceptable to both | |
4100 | languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current | |
4101 | source file were written in C, and _GDBN__ was parsing Modula-2, a | |
4102 | command such as: | |
4103 | ||
4104 | @example | |
4105 | print a = b + c | |
4106 | @end example | |
4107 | ||
4108 | @noindent | |
4109 | might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add | |
4110 | @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result | |
4111 | printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare | |
4112 | @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value. | |
4113 | ||
4114 | If you allow _GDBN__ to set the language automatically, then | |
4115 | you can count on expressions evaluating the same way in your debugging | |
4116 | session and in your program. | |
4117 | ||
4118 | @node Automatically, , Manually, Setting | |
4119 | @subsection Having _GDBN__ infer the source language | |
4120 | ||
4121 | To have _GDBN__ set the working language automatically, use @samp{set | |
4122 | language local} or @samp{set language auto}. _GDBN__ then infers the | |
4123 | language that a program was written in by looking at the name of its | |
4124 | source files, and examining their extensions: | |
4125 | ||
4126 | @table @file | |
4127 | @item *.mod | |
4128 | Modula-2 source file | |
4129 | ||
4130 | @item *.c | |
4131 | @itemx *.cc | |
4132 | C or C++ source file. | |
4133 | @end table | |
4134 | ||
4135 | This information is recorded for each function or procedure in a source | |
4136 | file. When your program stops in a frame (usually by encountering a | |
4137 | breakpoint), _GDBN__ sets the working language to the language recorded | |
4138 | for the function in that frame. If the language for a frame is unknown | |
4139 | (that is, if the function or block corresponding to the frame was | |
4140 | defined in a source file that does not have a recognized extension), the | |
4141 | current working language is not changed, and _GDBN__ issues a warning. | |
4142 | ||
4143 | This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written | |
4144 | entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries | |
4145 | written in one source language can be used by a main program written in | |
4146 | a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this | |
4147 | case frees you from having to set the working language manually. | |
4148 | ||
4149 | @node Show, Checks, Setting, Languages | |
4150 | @section Displaying the language | |
4151 | ||
4152 | The following commands will help you find out which language is the | |
4153 | working language, and also what language source files were written in. | |
4154 | ||
4155 | @kindex show language | |
4156 | @kindex info frame | |
4157 | @kindex info source | |
4158 | @table @code | |
4159 | @item show language | |
4160 | Display the current working language. This is the | |
4161 | language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to | |
4162 | build and compute expressions that may involve variables in the program. | |
4163 | ||
4164 | @item info frame | |
4165 | Among the other information listed here (@pxref{Frame Info,,Information | |
4166 | about a Frame}) is the source language for this frame. This is the | |
4167 | language that will become the working language if you ever use an | |
4168 | identifier that is in this frame. | |
4169 | ||
4170 | @item info source | |
4171 | Among the other information listed here (@pxref{Symbols,,Examining the | |
4172 | Symbol Table}) is the source language of this source file. | |
4173 | ||
4174 | @end table | |
4175 | ||
4176 | @node Checks, Support, Show, Languages | |
4177 | @section Type and range Checking | |
4178 | ||
4179 | @quotation | |
4180 | @emph{Warning:} In this release, the _GDBN__ commands for type and range | |
4181 | checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This | |
4182 | section documents the intended facilities. | |
4183 | @end quotation | |
4184 | @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added | |
4185 | ||
4186 | Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common | |
4187 | errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include | |
4188 | checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making | |
4189 | sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as | |
4190 | these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled | |
4191 | by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range | |
4192 | errors when the program is running. | |
4193 | ||
4194 | _GDBN__ can check for conditions like the above if you wish. | |
4195 | Although _GDBN__ will not check the statements in your program, it | |
4196 | can check expressions entered directly into _GDBN__ for evaluation via | |
4197 | the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language, | |
4198 | _GDBN__ can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on | |
4199 | the source language of the program being debugged. | |
4200 | @xref{Support,,Supported Languages}, for the default settings | |
4201 | of supported languages. | |
4202 | ||
4203 | @menu | |
4204 | * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking | |
4205 | * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking | |
4206 | @end menu | |
4207 | ||
4208 | @cindex type checking | |
4209 | @cindex checks, type | |
4210 | @node Type Checking, Range Checking, Checks, Checks | |
4211 | @subsection An overview of type checking | |
4212 | ||
4213 | Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the | |
4214 | arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type, | |
4215 | otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch | |
4216 | errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example, | |
4217 | ||
4218 | @example | |
4219 | 1 + 2 @result{} 3 | |
4220 | @error{} 1 + 2.3 | |
4221 | @end example | |
4222 | ||
4223 | The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not | |
4224 | type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3. | |
4225 | ||
4226 | For expressions you use in _GDBN__ commands, you can tell the _GDBN__ | |
4227 | type checker to skip checking; to treat any mismatches as errors and | |
4228 | abandon the expression; or only issue warnings when type mismatches | |
4229 | occur, but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of | |
4230 | these, _GDBN__ evaluates expressions like the second example above, but | |
4231 | also issues a warning. | |
4232 | ||
4233 | Even though you may turn type checking off, other type-based reasons may | |
4234 | prevent _GDBN__ from evaluating an expression. For instance, _GDBN__ does not | |
4235 | know how to add an @code{int} and a @code{struct foo}. These particular | |
4236 | type errors have nothing to do with the language in use, and usually | |
4237 | arise from expressions, such as the one described above, which make | |
4238 | little sense to evaluate anyway. | |
4239 | ||
4240 | Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For | |
4241 | instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical | |
4242 | operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be | |
4243 | represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical | |
4244 | operators. @xref{Support,,Supported Languages}, for futher | |
4245 | details on specific languages. | |
4246 | ||
4247 | _GDBN__ provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker: | |
4248 | ||
4249 | @kindex set check | |
4250 | @kindex set check type | |
4251 | @kindex show check type | |
4252 | @table @code | |
4253 | @item set check type auto | |
4254 | Set type checking on or off based on the current working language. | |
4255 | @xref{Support,,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for | |
4256 | each language. | |
4257 | ||
4258 | @item set check type on | |
4259 | @itemx set check type off | |
4260 | Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the | |
4261 | current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not | |
4262 | match the language's default. If any type mismatches occur in | |
4263 | evaluating an expression while typechecking is on, _GDBN__ prints a | |
4264 | message and aborts evaluation of the expression. | |
4265 | ||
4266 | @item set check type warn | |
4267 | Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to | |
4268 | evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still | |
4269 | be impossible for other reasons. For example, _GDBN__ cannot add | |
4270 | numbers and structures. | |
4271 | ||
4272 | @item show type | |
4273 | Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not _GDBN__ is | |
4274 | setting it automatically. | |
4275 | @end table | |
4276 | ||
4277 | @cindex range checking | |
4278 | @cindex checks, range | |
4279 | @node Range Checking, , Type Checking, Checks | |
4280 | @subsection An overview of Range Checking | |
4281 | ||
4282 | In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the | |
4283 | bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range | |
4284 | checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure | |
4285 | computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do | |
4286 | not exceed the bounds of the array. | |
4287 | ||
4288 | For expressions you use in _GDBN__ commands, you can tell _GDBN__ to | |
4289 | ignore range errors; to always treat them as errors and abandon the | |
4290 | expression; or to issue warnings when a range error occurs but evaluate | |
4291 | the expression anyway. | |
4292 | ||
4293 | A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an | |
4294 | array index bound, or when you type in a constant that is not a member | |
4295 | of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an | |
4296 | error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the | |
4297 | result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is | |
4298 | the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then | |
4299 | @example | |
4300 | @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s} | |
4301 | @end example | |
4302 | ||
4303 | This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases | |
4304 | specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support,, | |
4305 | Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages. | |
4306 | ||
4307 | _GDBN__ provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker: | |
4308 | ||
4309 | @kindex set check | |
4310 | @kindex set check range | |
4311 | @kindex show check range | |
4312 | @table @code | |
4313 | @item set check range auto | |
4314 | Set range checking on or off based on the current working language. | |
4315 | @xref{Support,,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for | |
4316 | each language. | |
4317 | ||
4318 | @item set check range on | |
4319 | @itemx set check range off | |
4320 | Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the | |
4321 | current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not | |
4322 | match the language's default. If a range error occurs, then a message | |
4323 | is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted. | |
4324 | ||
4325 | @item set check range warn | |
4326 | Output messages when the _GDBN__ range checker detects a range error, | |
4327 | but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the | |
4328 | expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing | |
4329 | memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many UNIX | |
4330 | systems). | |
4331 | ||
4332 | @item show range | |
4333 | Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is | |
4334 | being set automatically by _GDBN__. | |
4335 | @end table | |
4336 | ||
4337 | @node Support, , Checks, Languages | |
4338 | @section Supported Languages | |
4339 | ||
3e0d0a27 | 4340 | _GDBN__ _GDB_VN__ supports C, C++, and Modula-2. The syntax for C and C++ is |
c2bbbb22 RP |
4341 | so closely related that _GDBN__ does not distinguish the two. Some |
4342 | _GDBN__ features may be used in expressions regardless of the language | |
4343 | you use: the _GDBN__ @code{@@} and @code{::} operators, and the | |
4344 | @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of | |
4345 | any of the supported languages. | |
4346 | ||
4347 | The following sections detail to what degree each of these | |
4348 | source languages is supported by _GDBN__. These sections are | |
4349 | not meant to be language tutorials or references, but serve only as a | |
4350 | reference guide to what the _GDBN__ expression parser will accept, and | |
4351 | what input and output formats should look like for different languages. | |
4352 | There are many good books written on each of these languages; please | |
4353 | look to these for a language reference or tutorial. | |
4354 | ||
4355 | @menu | |
4356 | * C:: C and C++ | |
4357 | * Modula-2:: Modula-2 | |
4358 | @end menu | |
4359 | ||
4360 | @node C, Modula-2, Support, Support | |
4361 | @subsection C and C++ | |
4362 | @cindex C and C++ | |
4363 | ||
4364 | @cindex expressions in C or C++ | |
4365 | Since C and C++ are so closely related, _GDBN__ does not distinguish | |
4366 | between them when interpreting the expressions recognized in _GDBN__ | |
4367 | commands. | |
b80282d5 RP |
4368 | |
4369 | @cindex C++ | |
4370 | @kindex g++ | |
4371 | @cindex GNU C++ | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
4372 | The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the GNU C++ |
4373 | compiler and _GDBN__. Therefore, to debug your C++ code effectively, | |
4374 | you must compile your C++ programs with the GNU C++ compiler, | |
4375 | @code{g++}. | |
4376 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
4377 | |
4378 | @menu | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
4379 | * C Operators:: C and C++ Operators |
4380 | * C Constants:: C and C++ Constants | |
4381 | * Cplusplus expressions:: C++ Expressions | |
4382 | * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++ | |
4383 | * C Checks:: C and C++ Type and Range Checks | |
4384 | * Debugging C:: _GDBN__ and C | |
4385 | * Debugging C plus plus:: Special features for C++ | |
b80282d5 RP |
4386 | @end menu |
4387 | ||
c2bbbb22 RP |
4388 | @cindex C and C++ operators |
4389 | @node C Operators, C Constants, C, C | |
4390 | @subsubsection C and C++ Operators | |
4391 | ||
4392 | Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, | |
4393 | @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are | |
4394 | often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of C and C++, the | |
4395 | following definitions hold: | |
4396 | ||
4397 | @itemize @bullet | |
4398 | @item | |
4399 | @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class | |
4400 | specifiers, @code{char}, and @code{enum}s. | |
4401 | ||
4402 | @item | |
4403 | @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float} and @code{double}. | |
4404 | ||
4405 | @item | |
4406 | @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} | |
4407 | *)}. | |
4408 | ||
4409 | @item | |
4410 | @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above. | |
4411 | ||
4412 | @end itemize | |
4413 | ||
4414 | @noindent | |
4415 | The following operators are supported. They are listed here | |
4416 | in order of increasing precedence: | |
4417 | ||
4418 | @table @code | |
4419 | _0__ | |
4420 | @item , | |
4421 | The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list | |
4422 | are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire | |
4423 | expression being the last expression evaluated. | |
4424 | ||
4425 | @item = | |
4426 | Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value | |
4427 | assigned. Defined on scalar types. | |
4428 | ||
4429 | @item @var{op}= | |
4430 | Used in an expression of the form @var{a} @var{op}@code{=} @var{b}, and | |
4431 | translated to @var{a} @code{=} @var{a op b}. @var{op}@code{=} and | |
4432 | @code{=} have the same precendence. @var{op} is any one of the | |
4433 | operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&}, @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, | |
4434 | @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}. | |
4435 | ||
4436 | @item ?: | |
4437 | The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought | |
4438 | of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an | |
4439 | integral type. | |
4440 | ||
4441 | @item || | |
4442 | Logical OR. Defined on integral types. | |
4443 | ||
4444 | @item && | |
4445 | Logical AND. Defined on integral types. | |
4446 | ||
4447 | @item | | |
4448 | Bitwise OR. Defined on integral types. | |
4449 | ||
4450 | @item ^ | |
4451 | Bitwise exclusive-OR. Defined on integral types. | |
4452 | ||
4453 | @item & | |
4454 | Bitwise AND. Defined on integral types. | |
4455 | ||
4456 | @item ==@r{, }!= | |
4457 | Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these | |
4458 | expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true. | |
4459 | ||
4460 | @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>= | |
4461 | Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal. | |
4462 | Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false | |
4463 | and non-zero for true. | |
4464 | ||
4465 | @item <<@r{, }>> | |
4466 | left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types. | |
4467 | ||
4468 | @item @@ | |
4469 | The _GDBN__ ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions}). | |
4470 | ||
4471 | @item +@r{, }- | |
4472 | Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and | |
4473 | pointer types. | |
4474 | ||
4475 | @item *@r{, }/@r{, }% | |
4476 | Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are | |
4477 | defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on | |
4478 | integral types. | |
4479 | ||
4480 | @item ++@r{, }-- | |
4481 | Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the | |
4482 | operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression; | |
4483 | when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the | |
4484 | operation takes place. | |
4485 | ||
4486 | @item * | |
4487 | Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as | |
4488 | @code{++}. | |
4489 | ||
4490 | @item & | |
4491 | Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}. | |
4492 | ||
4493 | @item - | |
4494 | Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same | |
4495 | precedence as @code{++}. | |
4496 | ||
4497 | @item ! | |
4498 | Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as | |
4499 | @code{++}. | |
4500 | ||
4501 | @item ~ | |
4502 | Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as | |
4503 | @code{++}. | |
4504 | ||
4505 | @item .@r{, }-> | |
4506 | Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience, | |
4507 | _GDBN__ regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a | |
4508 | pointer based on the stored type information. | |
4509 | Defined on @code{struct}s and @code{union}s. | |
4510 | ||
4511 | @item [] | |
4512 | Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as | |
4513 | @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}. | |
4514 | ||
4515 | @item () | |
4516 | Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}. | |
4517 | ||
4518 | @item :: | |
4519 | C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on | |
4520 | @code{struct}, @code{union}, and @code{class} types. | |
4521 | ||
4522 | @item :: | |
4523 | The _GDBN__ scope operator (@pxref{Expressions}). Same precedence as | |
4524 | @code{::}, above. _1__ | |
4525 | @end table | |
4526 | ||
4527 | @cindex C and C++ constants | |
4528 | @node C Constants, Cplusplus expressions, C Operators, C | |
4529 | @subsubsection C and C++ Constants | |
4530 | ||
4531 | _GDBN__ allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the | |
4532 | following ways: | |
4533 | ||
4534 | @itemize @bullet | |
4535 | ||
4536 | @item | |
4537 | Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are | |
4538 | specified by a leading @samp{0} (ie. zero), and hexadecimal constants by | |
4539 | a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with an | |
4540 | @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a | |
4541 | @code{long} value. | |
4542 | ||
4543 | @item | |
4544 | Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal | |
4545 | point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an | |
4546 | exponent. An exponent is of the form: | |
4547 | @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another | |
4548 | sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents. | |
4549 | ||
4550 | @item | |
4551 | Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their | |
4552 | integral equivalents. | |
4553 | ||
4554 | @item | |
4555 | Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes | |
4556 | (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character | |
4557 | (usually its @sc{ASCII} value). Within quotes, the single character may | |
4558 | be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of | |
4559 | the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation | |
4560 | of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where | |
4561 | @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example, | |
4562 | @samp{\n} for newline. | |
4563 | ||
4564 | @item | |
4565 | String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded | |
4566 | by double quotes (@code{"}). | |
4567 | ||
4568 | @item | |
4569 | Pointer constants are an integral value. | |
4570 | ||
4571 | @end itemize | |
4572 | ||
4573 | ||
4574 | @node Cplusplus expressions, C Defaults, C Constants, C | |
4575 | @subsubsection C++ Expressions | |
b80282d5 RP |
4576 | |
4577 | @cindex expressions in C++ | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
4578 | _GDBN__'s expression handling has the following extensions to |
4579 | interpret a significant subset of C++ expressions: | |
b80282d5 RP |
4580 | |
4581 | @enumerate | |
4582 | ||
4583 | @cindex member functions | |
4584 | @item | |
4585 | Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like | |
4586 | @example | |
4587 | count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y) | |
4588 | @end example | |
4589 | ||
4590 | @kindex this | |
4591 | @cindex namespace in C++ | |
4592 | @item | |
4593 | While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your | |
4594 | expressions have the same namespace available as the member function; | |
4595 | that is, _GDBN__ allows implicit references to the class instance | |
4596 | pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++. | |
4597 | ||
4598 | @cindex call overloaded functions | |
4599 | @cindex type conversions in C++ | |
4600 | @item | |
4601 | You can call overloaded functions; _GDBN__ will resolve the function | |
4602 | call to the right definition, with one restriction---you must use | |
4603 | arguments of the type required by the function that you want to call. | |
4604 | _GDBN__ will not perform conversions requiring constructors or | |
4605 | user-defined type operators. | |
4606 | ||
4607 | @cindex reference declarations | |
4608 | @item | |
4609 | _GDBN__ understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use them in | |
4610 | expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically | |
4611 | dereferenced. | |
4612 | ||
4613 | In the parameter list shown when _GDBN__ displays a frame, the values of | |
4614 | reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this | |
4615 | avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures. | |
4616 | The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless | |
4617 | you've specified @samp{set print address off}. | |
4618 | ||
4619 | ||
4620 | @item | |
4621 | _GDBN__ supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
4622 | expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since |
4623 | one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if | |
4624 | necessary, for example in an expression like | |
4625 | @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. _GDBN__ also allows | |
4626 | resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++ | |
4627 | debugging; @pxref{Variables}. | |
b80282d5 RP |
4628 | |
4629 | @end enumerate | |
4630 | ||
c2bbbb22 RP |
4631 | |
4632 | @node C Defaults, C Checks, Cplusplus expressions, C | |
4633 | @subsubsection C and C++ Defaults | |
4634 | @cindex C and C++ defaults | |
4635 | ||
4636 | If you allow _GDBN__ to set type and range checking automatically, they | |
4637 | both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to | |
4638 | C/C++. This happens regardless of whether you, or _GDBN__, | |
4639 | selected the working language. | |
4640 | ||
4641 | If you allow _GDBN__ to set the language automatically, it sets the | |
4642 | working language to C/C++ on entering code compiled from a source file | |
4643 | whose name ends with @file{.c} or @file{.cc}. | |
4644 | @xref{Automatically,,Having _GDBN__ infer the source language}, for | |
4645 | further details. | |
4646 | ||
4647 | @node C Checks, Debugging C, C Defaults, C | |
4648 | @subsubsection C and C++ Type and Range Checks | |
4649 | @cindex C and C++ checks | |
4650 | ||
4651 | @quotation | |
4652 | @emph{Warning:} in this release, _GDBN__ does not yet perform type or | |
4653 | range checking. | |
4654 | @end quotation | |
4655 | @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added | |
4656 | ||
4657 | By default, when _GDBN__ parses C or C++ expressions, type checking | |
4658 | is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, _GDBN__ will | |
4659 | consider two variables type equivalent if: | |
4660 | ||
4661 | @itemize @bullet | |
4662 | @item | |
4663 | The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or | |
4664 | enumerated tag. | |
4665 | ||
4666 | @item | |
4667 | Two two variables have the same type name, or types that have been | |
4668 | declared equivalent through @code{typedef}. | |
4669 | ||
4670 | @ignore | |
4671 | @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it. | |
4672 | @c FIXME--beers? | |
4673 | @item | |
4674 | The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are | |
4675 | declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C | |
4676 | compilers.) | |
4677 | @end ignore | |
4678 | ||
4679 | @end itemize | |
4680 | ||
4681 | Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array | |
4682 | indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer | |
4683 | that is not itself an array. | |
4684 | ||
4685 | @node Debugging C, Debugging C plus plus, C Checks, C | |
4686 | @subsubsection _GDBN__ and C | |
4687 | ||
4688 | The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to | |
4689 | the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is | |
4690 | inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} will also be printed. | |
4691 | Otherwise, it will appear as @samp{@{...@}}. | |
4692 | ||
4693 | The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed | |
4694 | with pointers and a memory allocation function. (@pxref{Expressions}) | |
4695 | ||
4696 | @node Debugging C plus plus, , Debugging C, C | |
4697 | @subsubsection _GDBN__ Commands for C++ | |
b80282d5 RP |
4698 | |
4699 | @cindex commands for C++ | |
4700 | Some _GDBN__ commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are | |
4701 | designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary: | |
4702 | ||
4703 | @table @code | |
4704 | @cindex break in overloaded functions | |
4705 | @item @r{breakpoint menus} | |
4706 | When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded, | |
4707 | _GDBN__'s breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition | |
4708 | you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus}. | |
4709 | ||
4710 | @cindex overloading in C++ | |
4711 | @item rbreak @var{regex} | |
4712 | Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting | |
4713 | breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special | |
4714 | classes. | |
4715 | @xref{Set Breaks}. | |
4716 | ||
4717 | @cindex C++ exception handling | |
4718 | @item catch @var{exceptions} | |
4719 | @itemx info catch | |
4720 | Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Exception Handling}. | |
4721 | ||
4722 | @cindex inheritance | |
4723 | @item ptype @var{typename} | |
4724 | Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type | |
4725 | @var{typename}. | |
4726 | @xref{Symbols}. | |
4727 | ||
4728 | @cindex C++ symbol display | |
4729 | @item set print demangle | |
4730 | @itemx show print demangle | |
4731 | @itemx set print asm-demangle | |
4732 | @itemx show print asm-demangle | |
4733 | Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when | |
4734 | displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies. | |
4735 | @xref{Print Settings}. | |
4736 | ||
4737 | @item set print object | |
4738 | @itemx show print object | |
4739 | Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects. | |
4740 | @xref{Print Settings}. | |
4741 | ||
4742 | @item set print vtbl | |
4743 | @itemx show print vtbl | |
4744 | Control the format for printing virtual function tables. | |
4745 | @xref{Print Settings}. | |
4746 | ||
4747 | @end table | |
4748 | ||
c2bbbb22 RP |
4749 | |
4750 | @node Modula-2, , C, Support | |
4751 | @subsection Modula-2 | |
4752 | @cindex Modula-2 | |
4753 | ||
4754 | The extensions made to _GDBN__ to support Modula-2 support output | |
4755 | from the GNU Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being developed). | |
4756 | Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and attempting to | |
4757 | debug executables produced by them will most likely result in an error | |
4758 | as _GDBN__ reads in the executable's symbol table. | |
4759 | ||
4760 | @cindex expressions in Modula-2 | |
4761 | @menu | |
4762 | * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators | |
4763 | * Builtin Func/Proc:: Built-in Functions and Procedures | |
4764 | * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 Constants | |
4765 | * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2 | |
4766 | * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2 | |
4767 | * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 Type and Range Checks | |
4768 | * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.} | |
4769 | * GDB/M2:: _GDBN__ and Modula-2 | |
4770 | @end menu | |
4771 | ||
4772 | @node M2 Operators, Builtin Func/Proc, Modula-2, Modula-2 | |
4773 | @subsubsection Operators | |
4774 | @cindex Modula-2 operators | |
4775 | ||
4776 | Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, | |
4777 | @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are | |
4778 | often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the | |
4779 | following definitions hold: | |
4780 | ||
4781 | @itemize @bullet | |
4782 | ||
4783 | @item | |
4784 | @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and | |
4785 | their subranges. | |
4786 | ||
4787 | @item | |
4788 | @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges. | |
4789 | ||
4790 | @item | |
4791 | @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}. | |
4792 | ||
4793 | @item | |
4794 | @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO | |
4795 | @var{type}}. | |
4796 | ||
4797 | @item | |
4798 | @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above. | |
4799 | ||
4800 | @item | |
4801 | @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET}s and @code{BITSET}s. | |
4802 | ||
4803 | @item | |
4804 | @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}. | |
4805 | ||
4806 | @end itemize | |
4807 | ||
4808 | @noindent | |
4809 | The following operators are supported, and appear in order of | |
4810 | increasing precedence: | |
4811 | ||
4812 | @table @code | |
4813 | _0__ | |
4814 | @item , | |
4815 | Function argument or array index separator. | |
4816 | ||
4817 | @item := | |
4818 | Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is | |
4819 | @var{value}. | |
4820 | ||
4821 | @item <@r{, }> | |
4822 | Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated | |
4823 | types. | |
4824 | ||
4825 | @item <=@r{, }>= | |
4826 | Less than, greater than, less than or equal to, greater than or equal to | |
4827 | on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on | |
4828 | set types. Same precedence as @code{<}. | |
4829 | ||
4830 | @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }# | |
4831 | Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types. | |
4832 | Same precedence as @code{<}. In _GDBN__ scripts, only @code{<>} is | |
4833 | available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script | |
4834 | comment character. | |
4835 | ||
4836 | @item IN | |
4837 | Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members. | |
4838 | Same precedence as @code{<}. | |
4839 | ||
4840 | @item OR | |
4841 | Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types. | |
4842 | ||
4843 | @item AND@r{, }& | |
4844 | Boolean conjuction. Defined on boolean types. | |
4845 | ||
4846 | @item @@ | |
4847 | The _GDBN__ ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions}). | |
4848 | ||
4849 | @item +@r{, }- | |
4850 | Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union | |
4851 | and difference on set types. | |
4852 | ||
4853 | @item * | |
4854 | Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection | |
4855 | on set types. | |
4856 | ||
4857 | @item / | |
4858 | Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set | |
4859 | types. Same precedence as @code{*}. | |
4860 | ||
4861 | @item DIV@r{, }MOD | |
4862 | Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same | |
4863 | precedence as @code{*}. | |
4864 | ||
4865 | @item - | |
4866 | Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER}s and @code{REAL}s. | |
4867 | ||
4868 | @item ^ | |
4869 | Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. | |
4870 | ||
4871 | @item NOT | |
4872 | Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as | |
4873 | @code{^}. | |
4874 | ||
4875 | @item . | |
4876 | @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD}s. Same | |
4877 | precedence as @code{^}. | |
4878 | ||
4879 | @item [] | |
4880 | Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY}s. Same precedence as @code{^}. | |
4881 | ||
4882 | @item () | |
4883 | Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE}s. Same precedence | |
4884 | as @code{^}. | |
4885 | ||
4886 | @item ::@r{, }. | |
4887 | _GDBN__ and Modula-2 scope operators. | |
4888 | ||
4889 | @end table | |
4890 | ||
4891 | @quotation | |
4892 | @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so _GDBN__ | |
4893 | will treat the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators | |
4894 | @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#}, | |
4895 | @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error. | |
4896 | @end quotation | |
4897 | _1__ | |
4898 | ||
4899 | @cindex Modula-2 builtins | |
4900 | @node Builtin Func/Proc, M2 Constants, M2 Operators, Modula-2 | |
4901 | @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures | |
4902 | ||
4903 | Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions. | |
4904 | In describing these, the following metavariables are used: | |
4905 | ||
4906 | @table @var | |
4907 | ||
4908 | @item a | |
4909 | represents an @code{ARRAY} variable. | |
4910 | ||
4911 | @item c | |
4912 | represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable. | |
4913 | ||
4914 | @item i | |
4915 | represents a variable or constant of integral type. | |
4916 | ||
4917 | @item m | |
4918 | represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the | |
4919 | same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should | |
4920 | be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}. | |
4921 | ||
4922 | @item n | |
4923 | represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type. | |
4924 | ||
4925 | @item r | |
4926 | represents a variable or constant of floating-point type. | |
4927 | ||
4928 | @item t | |
4929 | represents a type. | |
4930 | ||
4931 | @item v | |
4932 | represents a variable. | |
4933 | ||
4934 | @item x | |
4935 | represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the | |
4936 | explanation of the function for details. | |
4937 | ||
4938 | @end table | |
4939 | ||
4940 | All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below. | |
4941 | ||
4942 | @table @code | |
4943 | @item ABS(@var{n}) | |
4944 | Returns the absolute value of @var{n}. | |
4945 | ||
4946 | @item CAP(@var{c}) | |
4947 | If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case | |
4948 | equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument | |
4949 | ||
4950 | @item CHR(@var{i}) | |
4951 | Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}. | |
4952 | ||
4953 | @item DEC(@var{v}) | |
4954 | Decrements the value in the variable @var{v}. Returns the new value. | |
4955 | ||
4956 | @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i}) | |
4957 | Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the | |
4958 | new value. | |
4959 | ||
4960 | @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s}) | |
4961 | Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new | |
4962 | set. | |
4963 | ||
4964 | @item FLOAT(@var{i}) | |
4965 | Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}. | |
4966 | ||
4967 | @item HIGH(@var{a}) | |
4968 | Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}. | |
4969 | ||
4970 | @item INC(@var{v}) | |
4971 | Increments the value in the variable @var{v}. Returns the new value. | |
4972 | ||
4973 | @item INC(@var{v},@var{i}) | |
4974 | Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the | |
4975 | new value. | |
4976 | ||
4977 | @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s}) | |
4978 | Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already | |
4979 | there. Returns the new set. | |
4980 | ||
4981 | @item MAX(@var{t}) | |
4982 | Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}. | |
4983 | ||
4984 | @item MIN(@var{t}) | |
4985 | Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}. | |
4986 | ||
4987 | @item ODD(@var{i}) | |
4988 | Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number. | |
4989 | ||
4990 | @item ORD(@var{x}) | |
4991 | Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal | |
4992 | value of a character is its ASCII value (on machines supporting the | |
4993 | ASCII character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include | |
4994 | integral, character and enumerated types. | |
4995 | ||
4996 | @item SIZE(@var{x}) | |
4997 | Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type. | |
4998 | ||
4999 | @item TRUNC(@var{r}) | |
5000 | Returns the integral part of @var{r}. | |
5001 | ||
5002 | @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i}) | |
5003 | Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}. | |
5004 | @end table | |
5005 | ||
5006 | @quotation | |
5007 | @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so | |
5008 | _GDBN__ will treat the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as | |
5009 | an error. | |
5010 | @end quotation | |
5011 | ||
5012 | @cindex Modula-2 constants | |
5013 | @node M2 Constants, M2 Defaults, Builtin Func/Proc, Modula-2 | |
5014 | @subsubsection Constants | |
5015 | ||
5016 | _GDBN__ allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following | |
5017 | ways: | |
5018 | ||
5019 | @itemize @bullet | |
5020 | ||
5021 | @item | |
5022 | Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an | |
5023 | expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the | |
5024 | rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a | |
5025 | trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}. | |
5026 | ||
5027 | @item | |
5028 | Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a | |
5029 | decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can | |
5030 | then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where | |
5031 | @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the | |
5032 | digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10) | |
5033 | digits. | |
5034 | ||
5035 | @item | |
5036 | Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of | |
5037 | like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may | |
5038 | also be expressed by their ordinal value (their ASCII value, usually) | |
5039 | followed by a @samp{C}. | |
5040 | ||
5041 | @item | |
5042 | String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a pair | |
5043 | of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). Escape | |
5044 | sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C Constants}, for a | |
5045 | brief explanation of escape sequences. | |
5046 | ||
5047 | @item | |
5048 | Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier. | |
5049 | ||
5050 | @item | |
5051 | Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and | |
5052 | @code{FALSE}. | |
5053 | ||
5054 | @item | |
5055 | Pointer constants consist of integral values only. | |
5056 | ||
5057 | @item | |
5058 | Set constants are not yet supported. | |
5059 | ||
5060 | @end itemize | |
5061 | ||
5062 | @node M2 Defaults, Deviations, M2 Constants, Modula-2 | |
5063 | @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults | |
5064 | @cindex Modula-2 defaults | |
5065 | ||
5066 | If type and range checking are set automatically by _GDBN__, they | |
5067 | both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to | |
5068 | Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you, or _GDBN__, | |
5069 | selected the working language. | |
5070 | ||
5071 | If you allow _GDBN__ to set the language automatically, then entering | |
5072 | code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} will set the | |
5073 | working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically,,Having _GDBN__ set | |
5074 | the language automatically}, for further details. | |
5075 | ||
5076 | @node Deviations, M2 Checks, M2 Defaults, Modula-2 | |
5077 | @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2 | |
5078 | @cindex Modula-2, deviations from | |
5079 | ||
5080 | A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug. | |
5081 | This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness: | |
5082 | ||
5083 | @itemize @bullet | |
5084 | @item | |
5085 | Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by | |
5086 | integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during | |
5087 | debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a | |
5088 | pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified | |
5089 | through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that | |
5090 | returned a pointer.) | |
5091 | ||
5092 | @item | |
5093 | C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent | |
5094 | non-printable characters. _GDBN__ will print out strings with these | |
5095 | escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are | |
5096 | printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format. | |
5097 | ||
5098 | @item | |
5099 | The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand | |
5100 | argument. | |
5101 | ||
5102 | @item | |
5103 | All builtin procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument. | |
5104 | ||
5105 | @end itemize | |
5106 | ||
5107 | @node M2 Checks, M2 Scope, Deviations, Modula-2 | |
5108 | @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks | |
5109 | @cindex Modula-2 checks | |
5110 | ||
5111 | @quotation | |
5112 | @emph{Warning:} in this release, _GDBN__ does not yet perform type or | |
5113 | range checking. | |
5114 | @end quotation | |
5115 | @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added | |
5116 | ||
5117 | _GDBN__ considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if: | |
5118 | ||
5119 | @itemize @bullet | |
5120 | @item | |
5121 | They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE | |
5122 | @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement | |
5123 | ||
5124 | @item | |
5125 | They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the | |
5126 | GNU Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.) | |
5127 | ||
5128 | @end itemize | |
5129 | ||
5130 | As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables | |
5131 | whose types are not equivalent is an error. | |
5132 | ||
5133 | Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array | |
5134 | index bounds, and all builtin functions and procedures. | |
5135 | ||
5136 | @node M2 Scope, GDB/M2, M2 Checks, Modula-2 | |
5137 | @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.} | |
5138 | @cindex scope | |
5139 | @kindex . | |
5140 | @kindex :: | |
5141 | ||
5142 | There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator | |
5143 | (@code{.}) and the _GDBN__ scope operator (@code{::}). The two have | |
5144 | similar syntax: | |
5145 | ||
5146 | @example | |
5147 | ||
5148 | @var{module} . @var{id} | |
5149 | @var{scope} :: @var{id} | |
5150 | ||
5151 | @end example | |
5152 | ||
5153 | @noindent | |
5154 | where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure, | |
5155 | @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any delcared | |
5156 | identifier within the program, except another module. | |
5157 | ||
5158 | Using the @code{::} operator makes _GDBN__ search the scope | |
5159 | specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not | |
5160 | found in the specified scope, then _GDBN__ will search all scopes | |
5161 | enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}. | |
5162 | ||
5163 | Using the @code{.} operator makes _GDBN__ search the current scope for | |
5164 | the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the | |
5165 | definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is | |
5166 | an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition | |
5167 | module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in | |
5168 | @var{module}. | |
5169 | ||
5170 | @node GDB/M2, , M2 Scope, Modula-2 | |
5171 | @subsubsection _GDBN__ and Modula-2 | |
5172 | ||
5173 | Some _GDBN__ commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs. | |
5174 | Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply | |
5175 | specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle}, | |
5176 | @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four | |
5177 | apply to C++, and the last to C's @code{union} type, which has no direct | |
5178 | analogue in Modula-2. | |
5179 | ||
5180 | The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions}), while available | |
5181 | while using any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its | |
5182 | intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be | |
5183 | created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an | |
5184 | address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct | |
5185 | @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful. (@pxref{Expressions}) | |
5186 | ||
5187 | _0__ | |
5188 | @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2 | |
5189 | In _GDBN__ scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is | |
5190 | interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead. | |
5191 | _1__ | |
5192 | ||
5193 | ||
5194 | @node Symbols, Altering, Languages, Top | |
70b88761 RP |
5195 | @chapter Examining the Symbol Table |
5196 | ||
5197 | The commands described in this section allow you to inquire about the | |
5198 | symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your | |
5199 | program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and | |
5200 | does not change as the program executes. _GDBN__ finds it in your | |
5201 | program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started _GDBN__ | |
5202 | (@pxref{File Options}), or by one of the file-management commands | |
5203 | (@pxref{Files}). | |
5204 | ||
5205 | @table @code | |
5206 | @item info address @var{symbol} | |
5207 | @kindex info address | |
5208 | Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register | |
5209 | variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register | |
5210 | local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable | |
5211 | is always stored. | |
5212 | ||
5213 | Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work | |
5214 | at all for a register variables, and for a stack local variable prints | |
5215 | the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable. | |
5216 | ||
5217 | @item whatis @var{exp} | |
5218 | @kindex whatis | |
5219 | Print the data type of expression @var{exp}. @var{exp} is not | |
5220 | actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as | |
5221 | assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. | |
5222 | @xref{Expressions}. | |
5223 | ||
5224 | @item whatis | |
5225 | Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history. | |
5226 | ||
5227 | @item ptype @var{typename} | |
5228 | @kindex ptype | |
5229 | Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be | |
5230 | the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form | |
5231 | @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or | |
5232 | @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.@refill | |
5233 | ||
5234 | @item ptype @var{exp} | |
5235 | Print a description of the type of expression @var{exp}. @code{ptype} | |
5236 | differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead of just | |
5237 | the name of the type. For example, if your program declares a variable | |
5238 | as | |
5239 | @example | |
5240 | struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v; | |
5241 | @end example | |
5242 | @noindent | |
5243 | compare the output of the two commands: | |
5244 | @example | |
5245 | (_GDBP__) whatis v | |
5246 | type = struct complex | |
5247 | (_GDBP__) ptype v | |
5248 | type = struct complex @{ | |
5249 | double real; | |
5250 | double imag; | |
5251 | @} | |
5252 | @end example | |
5253 | ||
5254 | @item info types @var{regexp} | |
5255 | @itemx info types | |
5256 | @kindex info types | |
5257 | Print a brief description of all types whose name matches @var{regexp} | |
5258 | (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each | |
5259 | complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus, | |
5260 | @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose | |
5261 | name includes the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives | |
5262 | information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}. | |
5263 | ||
5264 | This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like | |
5265 | @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it | |
5266 | lists all source files where a type is defined. | |
5267 | ||
5268 | @item info source | |
5269 | @kindex info source | |
5270 | Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
5271 | the function containing the current point of execution---and the language |
5272 | it was written in. | |
70b88761 RP |
5273 | |
5274 | @item info sources | |
5275 | @kindex info sources | |
5276 | Print the names of all source files in the program for which there is | |
b80282d5 RP |
5277 | debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols |
5278 | have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed. | |
70b88761 RP |
5279 | |
5280 | @item info functions | |
5281 | @kindex info functions | |
5282 | Print the names and data types of all defined functions. | |
5283 | ||
5284 | @item info functions @var{regexp} | |
5285 | Print the names and data types of all defined functions | |
5286 | whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}. | |
5287 | Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names | |
5288 | include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names | |
5289 | start with @code{step}. | |
5290 | ||
5291 | @item info variables | |
5292 | @kindex info variables | |
5293 | Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared | |
5294 | outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables). | |
5295 | ||
5296 | @item info variables @var{regexp} | |
5297 | Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local | |
5298 | variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression | |
5299 | @var{regexp}. | |
5300 | ||
5301 | ||
5302 | @ignore | |
5303 | This was never implemented. | |
5304 | @item info methods | |
5305 | @itemx info methods @var{regexp} | |
5306 | @kindex info methods | |
5307 | The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined | |
5308 | methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a | |
5309 | specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many | |
5310 | C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output | |
5311 | from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The | |
5312 | @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those | |
5313 | which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}. | |
5314 | @end ignore | |
5315 | ||
5316 | @item printsyms @var{filename} | |
5317 | @kindex printsyms | |
b80282d5 RP |
5318 | Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file |
5319 | @var{filename}. Only symbols with debugging data are included. _GDBN__ | |
5320 | includes all the symbols it already knows about: that is, @var{filename} | |
5321 | reflects symbols for only those files whose symbols _GDBN__ has read. | |
5322 | You can find out which files these are using the command @code{info | |
5323 | files}. The description of @code{symbol-file} describes how _GDBN__ | |
5324 | reads symbols; both commands are described under @ref{Files}. | |
70b88761 RP |
5325 | @end table |
5326 | ||
5327 | @node Altering, _GDBN__ Files, Symbols, Top | |
5328 | @chapter Altering Execution | |
5329 | ||
5330 | Once you think you have found an error in the program, you might want to | |
5331 | find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to | |
5332 | correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by | |
5333 | experiment, using the _GDBN__ features for altering execution of the | |
5334 | program. | |
5335 | ||
5336 | For example, you can store new values into variables or memory | |
5337 | locations, give the program a signal, restart it at a different address, | |
5338 | or even return prematurely from a function to its caller. | |
5339 | ||
5340 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
5341 | * Assignment:: Assignment to Variables |
5342 | * Jumping:: Continuing at a Different Address | |
5343 | * Signaling:: Giving the Program a Signal | |
5344 | * Returning:: Returning from a Function | |
5345 | * Calling:: Calling your Program's Functions | |
c338a2fd | 5346 | * Patching:: Patching your Program |
70b88761 RP |
5347 | @end menu |
5348 | ||
5349 | @node Assignment, Jumping, Altering, Altering | |
5350 | @section Assignment to Variables | |
5351 | ||
5352 | @cindex assignment | |
5353 | @cindex setting variables | |
5354 | To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression. | |
5355 | @xref{Expressions}. For example, | |
5356 | ||
5357 | @example | |
5358 | print x=4 | |
5359 | @end example | |
5360 | ||
5361 | @noindent | |
5362 | would store the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then print the | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
5363 | value of the assignment expression (which is 4). @xref{Languages}, for |
5364 | more information on operators in supported languages. | |
70b88761 | 5365 | |
70b88761 RP |
5366 | @kindex set variable |
5367 | @cindex variables, setting | |
5368 | If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the | |
5369 | @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is | |
5370 | really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is not | |
5371 | printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History}). The | |
5372 | expression is evaluated only for its effects. | |
5373 | ||
5374 | If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command | |
5375 | appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set | |
5376 | variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical | |
5377 | to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, a | |
5378 | program might well have a variable @code{width}---which leads to | |
5379 | an error if we try to set a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, as | |
5380 | we might if @code{set width} didn't happen to be a _GDBN__ command: | |
5381 | @example | |
5382 | (_GDBP__) whatis width | |
5383 | type = double | |
5384 | (_GDBP__) p width | |
5385 | $4 = 13 | |
5386 | (_GDBP__) set width=47 | |
5387 | Invalid syntax in expression. | |
5388 | @end example | |
5389 | @noindent | |
5390 | The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. What we can do in | |
5391 | order to actually set our program's variable @code{width} is | |
5392 | @example | |
5393 | (_GDBP__) set var width=47 | |
5394 | @end example | |
5395 | ||
5396 | _GDBN__ allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C does; you can | |
5397 | freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa, and | |
5398 | any structure can be converted to any other structure that is the same | |
5399 | length or shorter. | |
5400 | @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions? | |
5401 | @comment /[email protected] 18dec1990 | |
5402 | ||
5403 | To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}} | |
5404 | construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address | |
5405 | (@pxref{Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers | |
5406 | to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size | |
5407 | and representation in memory), and | |
5408 | ||
5409 | @example | |
5410 | set @{int@}0x83040 = 4 | |
5411 | @end example | |
5412 | ||
5413 | @noindent | |
5414 | stores the value 4 into that memory location. | |
5415 | ||
5416 | @node Jumping, Signaling, Assignment, Altering | |
5417 | @section Continuing at a Different Address | |
5418 | ||
5419 | Ordinarily, when you continue the program, you do so at the place where | |
5420 | it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at | |
5421 | an address of your own choosing, with the following commands: | |
5422 | ||
5423 | @table @code | |
5424 | @item jump @var{linespec} | |
5425 | @kindex jump | |
5426 | Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution will stop | |
5427 | immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List} for a | |
5428 | description of the different forms of @var{linespec}. | |
5429 | ||
5430 | The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or | |
5431 | the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any | |
5432 | register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in | |
5433 | a different function from the one currently executing, the results may | |
5434 | be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or | |
5435 | of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests | |
5436 | confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently | |
5437 | executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are | |
5438 | well acquainted with the machine-language code of the program. | |
5439 | ||
5440 | @item jump *@var{address} | |
5441 | Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}. | |
5442 | @end table | |
5443 | ||
5444 | You can get much the same effect as the @code{jump} command by storing a | |
5445 | new value into the register @code{$pc}. The difference is that this | |
5446 | does not start the program running; it only changes the address where it | |
5447 | @emph{will} run when it is continued. For example, | |
5448 | ||
5449 | @example | |
5450 | set $pc = 0x485 | |
5451 | @end example | |
5452 | ||
5453 | @noindent | |
5454 | causes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command to execute at | |
5455 | address 0x485, rather than at the address where the program stopped. | |
3d3ab540 | 5456 | @xref{Continuing and Stepping}. |
70b88761 RP |
5457 | |
5458 | The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back up, | |
5459 | perhaps with more breakpoints set, over a portion of a program that has | |
5460 | already executed, in order to examine its execution in more detail. | |
5461 | ||
5462 | @node Signaling, Returning, Jumping, Altering | |
5463 | @c @group | |
5464 | @section Giving the Program a Signal | |
5465 | ||
5466 | @table @code | |
5467 | @item signal @var{signalnum} | |
5468 | @kindex signal | |
5469 | Resume execution where the program stopped, but give it immediately the | |
5470 | signal number @var{signalnum}. | |
5471 | ||
5472 | Alternatively, if @var{signalnum} is zero, continue execution without | |
5473 | giving a signal. This is useful when the program stopped on account of | |
5474 | a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the | |
5475 | @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a | |
5476 | signal. | |
5477 | ||
5478 | @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time | |
5479 | after executing the command. | |
5480 | @end table | |
5481 | @c @end group | |
5482 | ||
5483 | @node Returning, Calling, Signaling, Altering | |
5484 | @section Returning from a Function | |
5485 | ||
5486 | @table @code | |
5487 | @item return | |
5488 | @itemx return @var{expression} | |
5489 | @cindex returning from a function | |
5490 | @kindex return | |
5491 | You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return} | |
5492 | command. If you give an | |
5493 | @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return | |
5494 | value. | |
5495 | @end table | |
5496 | ||
5497 | When you use @code{return}, _GDBN__ discards the selected stack frame | |
5498 | (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the | |
5499 | discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to | |
5500 | be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}. | |
5501 | ||
5502 | This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection}), and any other | |
5503 | frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the innermost remaining | |
5504 | frame. That frame becomes selected. The specified value is stored in | |
5505 | the registers used for returning values of functions. | |
5506 | ||
5507 | The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the | |
5508 | program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just | |
3d3ab540 RP |
5509 | returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing and |
5510 | Stepping}) resumes execution until the selected stack frame returns | |
5511 | naturally.@refill | |
70b88761 | 5512 | |
c338a2fd | 5513 | @node Calling, Patching, Returning, Altering |
70b88761 RP |
5514 | @section Calling your Program's Functions |
5515 | ||
5516 | @cindex calling functions | |
5517 | @kindex call | |
5518 | @table @code | |
5519 | @item call @var{expr} | |
5520 | Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void} | |
5521 | returned values. | |
5522 | @end table | |
5523 | ||
5524 | You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to | |
5525 | execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output | |
5526 | with @code{void} returned values. The result is printed and saved in | |
5527 | the value history, if it is not void. | |
5528 | ||
c338a2fd RP |
5529 | @node Patching, , Calling, Altering |
5530 | @section Patching your Program | |
5531 | @cindex patching binaries | |
5532 | @cindex writing into executables | |
5533 | @cindex writing into corefiles | |
5534 | By default, _GDBN__ opens the file containing your program's executable | |
5535 | code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental alterations | |
5536 | to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally patching | |
5537 | your program's binary. | |
5538 | ||
5539 | If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that | |
5540 | explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might | |
5541 | want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency | |
5542 | repairs. | |
5543 | ||
5544 | @table @code | |
5545 | @item set write on | |
5546 | @itemx set write off | |
5547 | @kindex set write | |
5548 | If you specify @samp{set write on}, _GDBN__ will open executable and | |
5549 | core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write | |
5550 | off} (the default), _GDBN__ will open them read-only. | |
5551 | ||
5552 | If you've already loaded a file, you must load it | |
5553 | again (using the @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after | |
5554 | changing @code{set write}, for your new setting to take effect. | |
5555 | ||
5556 | @item show write | |
5557 | Display whether executable files and core files will be opened for | |
5558 | writing as well as reading. | |
5559 | ||
5560 | @end table | |
5561 | ||
70b88761 RP |
5562 | @node _GDBN__ Files, Targets, Altering, Top |
5563 | @chapter _GDBN__'s Files | |
5564 | ||
5565 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
5566 | * Files:: Commands to Specify Files |
5567 | * Symbol Errors:: Errors Reading Symbol Files | |
70b88761 RP |
5568 | @end menu |
5569 | ||
5570 | @node Files, Symbol Errors, _GDBN__ Files, _GDBN__ Files | |
5571 | @section Commands to Specify Files | |
5572 | @cindex core dump file | |
5573 | @cindex symbol table | |
5574 | _GDBN__ needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged, both in | |
5575 | order to read its symbol table and in order to start the program. To | |
5576 | debug a core dump of a previous run, _GDBN__ must be told the file name of | |
5577 | the core dump. | |
5578 | ||
5579 | The usual way to specify the executable and core dump file names is with | |
5580 | the command arguments given when you start _GDBN__, as discussed in | |
5581 | @pxref{Invocation}. | |
5582 | ||
5583 | Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a | |
5584 | _GDBN__ session. Or you may run _GDBN__ and forget to specify the files you | |
5585 | want to use. In these situations the _GDBN__ commands to specify new files | |
5586 | are useful. | |
5587 | ||
5588 | @table @code | |
5589 | @item file @var{filename} | |
5590 | @cindex executable file | |
5591 | @kindex file | |
5592 | Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its | |
5593 | symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program | |
5594 | executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a | |
5595 | directory and the file is not found in _GDBN__'s working directory, | |
5596 | ||
5597 | _GDBN__ uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of | |
5598 | directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program | |
5599 | to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both _GDBN__ and | |
5600 | your program, using the @code{path} command. | |
5601 | ||
5602 | @code{file} with no argument makes _GDBN__ discard any information it | |
5603 | has on both executable file and the symbol table. | |
5604 | ||
5605 | @item exec-file @var{filename} | |
5606 | @kindex exec-file | |
5607 | Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found | |
5608 | in @var{filename}. _GDBN__ will search the environment variable @code{PATH} | |
5609 | if necessary to locate the program. | |
5610 | ||
5611 | @item symbol-file @var{filename} | |
5612 | @kindex symbol-file | |
5613 | Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is | |
5614 | searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol | |
5615 | table and program to run from the same file. | |
5616 | ||
5617 | @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out _GDBN__'s information on your | |
5618 | program's symbol table. | |
5619 | ||
5620 | The @code{symbol-file} command causes _GDBN__ to forget the contents of its | |
5621 | convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and | |
5622 | auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to | |
5623 | the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of | |
5624 | the old symbol table data being discarded inside _GDBN__. | |
5625 | ||
5626 | @code{symbol-file} will not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after | |
5627 | executing it once. | |
5628 | ||
5629 | On some kinds of object files, the @code{symbol-file} command does not | |
5630 | actually read the symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans | |
5631 | the symbol table quickly to find which source files and which symbols | |
5632 | are present. The details are read later, one source file at a time, | |
5633 | when they are needed. | |
5634 | ||
5635 | The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make _GDBN__ start up | |
5636 | faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for occasional pauses | |
5637 | while the symbol table details for a particular source file are being | |
5638 | read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these pauses into | |
5639 | messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings}). | |
5640 | ||
5641 | When the symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} does | |
5642 | read the symbol table data in full right away. We haven't implemented | |
5643 | the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. | |
5644 | ||
5645 | When _GDBN__ is configured for a particular environment, it will | |
5646 | understand debugging information in whatever format is the standard | |
5647 | generated for that environment; you may use either a GNU compiler, or | |
5648 | other compilers that adhere to the local conventions. Best results are | |
5649 | usually obtained from GNU compilers; for example, using @code{_GCC__} | |
5650 | you can generate debugging information for optimized code. | |
5651 | ||
5652 | @item core-file @var{filename} | |
5653 | @itemx core @var{filename} | |
5654 | @kindex core | |
5655 | @kindex core-file | |
5656 | Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents | |
5657 | of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the | |
5658 | address space of the process that generated them; _GDBN__ can access the | |
5659 | executable file itself for other parts. | |
5660 | ||
5661 | @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is | |
5662 | to be used. | |
5663 | ||
5664 | Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running | |
5665 | under _GDBN__. So, if you have been running the program and you wish to | |
5666 | debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which the | |
5667 | program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command | |
5668 | (@pxref{Kill Process}). | |
5669 | ||
5670 | @item load @var{filename} | |
5671 | @kindex load | |
5672 | _if__(_GENERIC__) | |
5673 | Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into | |
5674 | _GDBN__, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it | |
5675 | is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging | |
5676 | on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example. | |
5677 | @code{load} also records @var{filename}'s symbol table in _GDBN__, like | |
5678 | the @code{add-symbol-file} command. | |
5679 | ||
5680 | If @code{load} is not available on your _GDBN__, attempting to execute | |
5681 | it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your target is | |
5682 | @dots{}}'' | |
5683 | _fi__(_GENERIC__) | |
5684 | ||
5685 | _if__(_VXWORKS__) | |
5686 | On VxWorks, @code{load} will dynamically link @var{filename} on the | |
5687 | current target system as well as adding its symbols in _GDBN__. | |
5688 | _fi__(_VXWORKS__) | |
5689 | ||
5690 | _if__(_I960__) | |
5691 | @cindex download to Nindy-960 | |
5692 | With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load} will | |
5693 | download @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in | |
5694 | _GDBN__. | |
5695 | _fi__(_I960__) | |
5696 | ||
5697 | @code{load} will not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it. | |
5698 | ||
5699 | @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} | |
5700 | @kindex add-symbol-file | |
5701 | @cindex dynamic linking | |
5702 | The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table information | |
b80282d5 | 5703 | from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command when @var{filename} |
70b88761 RP |
5704 | has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) into the program that |
5705 | is running. @var{address} should be the memory address at which the | |
5706 | file has been loaded; _GDBN__ cannot figure this out for itself. | |
5707 | ||
5708 | The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table | |
5709 | originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the | |
5710 | @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data thus | |
5711 | read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data instead, | |
5712 | use the @code{symbol-file} command. | |
5713 | ||
5714 | @code{add-symbol-file} will not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. | |
5715 | ||
5716 | @item info files | |
5717 | @itemx info target | |
5718 | @kindex info files | |
5719 | @kindex info target | |
5720 | @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the | |
5721 | current targets (@pxref{Targets}), including the names of the executable | |
5722 | and core dump files currently in use by _GDBN__, and the files from | |
5723 | which symbols were loaded. The command @code{help targets} lists all | |
5724 | possible targets rather than current ones. | |
5725 | ||
5726 | @end table | |
5727 | ||
5728 | All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names | |
5729 | as arguments. _GDBN__ always converts the file name to an absolute path | |
5730 | name and remembers it that way. | |
5731 | ||
70b88761 RP |
5732 | @cindex shared libraries |
5733 | ||
c338a2fd RP |
5734 | _GDBN__ supports the SunOS shared library format. _GDBN__ automatically |
5735 | loads symbol definitions from shared libraries when you use the | |
5736 | @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file. (Before you issue | |
5737 | the @code{run} command, _GDBN__ won't understand references to a | |
5738 | function in a shared library, however---unless you're debugging a core | |
5739 | file). | |
5740 | @c FIXME: next _GDBN__ release should permit some refs to undef | |
5741 | @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they're from a shared lib | |
70b88761 RP |
5742 | |
5743 | @table @code | |
70b88761 RP |
5744 | @item info share |
5745 | @itemx info sharedlibrary | |
5746 | @kindex info sharedlibrary | |
5747 | @kindex info share | |
c338a2fd | 5748 | Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded. |
70b88761 | 5749 | |
c338a2fd RP |
5750 | @item sharedlibrary @var{regex} |
5751 | @itemx share @var{regex} | |
5752 | @kindex sharedlibrary | |
5753 | @kindex share | |
5754 | This is an obsolescent command; you can use it to explicitly | |
5755 | load shared object library symbols for files matching a UNIX regular | |
5756 | expression, but as with files loaded automatically, it will only load | |
5757 | shared libraries required by your program for a core file or after | |
5758 | typing @code{run}. If @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries | |
5759 | required by your program are loaded. | |
5760 | @end table | |
70b88761 RP |
5761 | |
5762 | @node Symbol Errors, , Files, _GDBN__ Files | |
5763 | @section Errors Reading Symbol Files | |
b80282d5 | 5764 | While reading a symbol file, _GDBN__ will occasionally encounter |
70b88761 | 5765 | problems, such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in |
b80282d5 RP |
5766 | compiler output. By default, _GDBN__ does not notify you of such |
5767 | problems, since they're relatively common and primarily of interest to | |
5768 | people debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information | |
5769 | about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask _GDBN__ to print | |
5770 | only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many | |
5771 | times the problem occurs; or you can ask _GDBN__ to print more messages, | |
5772 | to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set complaints} | |
5773 | command (@xref{Messages/Warnings}). | |
70b88761 RP |
5774 | |
5775 | The messages currently printed, and their meanings, are: | |
5776 | ||
5777 | @table @code | |
5778 | @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol} | |
5779 | ||
5780 | The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end | |
5781 | (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This | |
5782 | error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained | |
5783 | in its outer scope blocks. | |
5784 | ||
5785 | _GDBN__ circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had | |
5786 | the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol} | |
5787 | may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a | |
5788 | function. | |
5789 | ||
5790 | @item block at @var{address} out of order | |
5791 | ||
5792 | The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in | |
5793 | order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not | |
5794 | do so. | |
5795 | ||
5796 | _GDBN__ does not circumvent this problem, and will have trouble locating | |
5797 | symbols in the source file whose symbols being read. (You can often | |
5798 | determine what source file is affected by specifying @code{set verbose | |
5799 | on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings}.) | |
5800 | ||
5801 | @item bad block start address patched | |
5802 | ||
5803 | The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address | |
5804 | smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known | |
5805 | to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler. | |
5806 | ||
5807 | _GDBN__ circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as | |
5808 | starting on the previous source line. | |
5809 | ||
70b88761 RP |
5810 | @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n} |
5811 | ||
5812 | @cindex foo | |
5813 | Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is | |
5814 | larger than the size of the string table. | |
5815 | ||
5816 | _GDBN__ circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the | |
5817 | name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up | |
5818 | with this name. | |
5819 | ||
5820 | @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}} | |
5821 | ||
5822 | The symbol information contains new data types that _GDBN__ does not yet | |
5823 | know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the misunderstood | |
5824 | information, in hexadecimal. | |
5825 | ||
5826 | _GDBN__ circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information. This | |
5827 | will usually allow the program to be debugged, though certain symbols | |
5828 | will not be accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like | |
5829 | debugging it, you can debug @code{_GDBP__} with itself, breakpoint on | |
5830 | @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab} and | |
5831 | examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol. | |
5832 | ||
5833 | @item stub type has NULL name | |
5834 | _GDBN__ could not find the full definition for a struct or class. | |
5835 | ||
5836 | @ignore | |
5837 | @c this is #if 0'd in dbxread.c as of (at least!) 17 may 1991 | |
5838 | @item const/volatile indicator missing, got '@var{X}' | |
5839 | ||
5840 | The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some | |
5841 | information that the compiler should have output for it. | |
5842 | @end ignore | |
5843 | ||
5844 | @item C++ type mismatch between compiler and debugger | |
5845 | ||
3d3ab540 | 5846 | _GDBN__ could not parse a type specification output by the compiler |
70b88761 RP |
5847 | for some C++ object. |
5848 | ||
5849 | @end table | |
5850 | ||
5851 | @node Targets, Controlling _GDBN__, _GDBN__ Files, Top | |
5852 | @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target | |
5853 | @cindex debugging target | |
5854 | @kindex target | |
5855 | A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular | |
5856 | kind of file or process. | |
5857 | ||
5858 | Often, you will be able to run _GDBN__ in the same host environment as the | |
5859 | program you are debugging; in that case, the debugging target can just be | |
5860 | specified as a side effect of the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. | |
5861 | When you need more flexibility---for example, running _GDBN__ on a | |
5862 | physically separate host, controlling standalone systems over a | |
5863 | serial port, or realtime systems over a TCP/IP connection---you can use | |
5864 | the @code{target} command. | |
5865 | ||
5866 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
5867 | * Active Targets:: Active Targets |
5868 | * Target Commands:: Commands for Managing Targets | |
5869 | * Remote:: Remote Debugging | |
70b88761 RP |
5870 | @end menu |
5871 | ||
5872 | @node Active Targets, Target Commands, Targets, Targets | |
5873 | @section Active Targets | |
5874 | @cindex stacking targets | |
5875 | @cindex active targets | |
5876 | @cindex multiple targets | |
5877 | ||
5878 | Targets are managed in three @dfn{strata} that correspond to different | |
5879 | classes of target: processes, core files, and executable files. This | |
5880 | allows you to (for example) start a process and inspect its activity | |
5881 | without abandoning your work on a core file. | |
5882 | ||
5883 | More than one target can potentially respond to a request. In | |
5884 | particular, when you access memory _GDBN__ will examine the three strata of | |
5885 | targets until it finds a target that can handle that particular address. | |
5886 | Strata are always examined in a fixed order: first a process if there is | |
5887 | one, then a core file if there is one, and finally an executable file if | |
5888 | there is one of those. | |
5889 | ||
5890 | When you specify a new target in a given stratum, it replaces any target | |
5891 | previously in that stratum. | |
5892 | ||
5893 | To get rid of a target without replacing it, use the @code{detach} | |
5894 | command. The related command @code{attach} provides you with a way of | |
5895 | choosing a particular running process as a new target. @xref{Attach}. | |
5896 | ||
5897 | @node Target Commands, Remote, Active Targets, Targets | |
5898 | @section Commands for Managing Targets | |
5899 | ||
5900 | @table @code | |
5901 | @item target @var{type} @var{parameters} | |
5902 | Connects the _GDBN__ host environment to a target machine or process. A | |
5903 | target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging facilities. You | |
5904 | use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or protocol of the | |
5905 | target machine. | |
5906 | ||
5907 | Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but | |
5908 | typically include things like device names or host names to connect | |
5909 | with, process numbers, and baud rates. | |
5910 | ||
5911 | The @code{target} command will not repeat if you press @key{RET} again | |
5912 | after executing the command. | |
5913 | ||
5914 | @item help target | |
5915 | @kindex help target | |
5916 | Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets | |
5917 | currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files} | |
5918 | (@pxref{Files}). | |
5919 | ||
5920 | @item help target @var{name} | |
5921 | Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to | |
5922 | select it. | |
5923 | @end table | |
5924 | ||
5925 | Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the _GDBN__ | |
5926 | configuration): | |
5927 | ||
5928 | @table @code | |
5929 | @item target exec @var{prog} | |
5930 | @kindex target exec | |
5931 | An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{prog}} is the same as | |
5932 | @samp{exec-file @var{prog}}. | |
5933 | ||
5934 | @item target core @var{filename} | |
5935 | @kindex target core | |
5936 | A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as | |
5937 | @samp{core-file @var{filename}}. | |
5938 | ||
5939 | @item target remote @var{dev} | |
5940 | @kindex target remote | |
5941 | Remote serial target in _GDBN__-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev} | |
5942 | specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g. | |
5943 | @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote}. | |
5944 | ||
5945 | _if__(_AMD29K__) | |
5946 | @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG} | |
5947 | @kindex target amd-eb | |
5948 | @cindex AMD EB29K | |
5949 | Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines. | |
5950 | @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote}; | |
5951 | @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the | |
5952 | name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC. | |
5953 | @xref{EB29K Remote}. | |
5954 | ||
5955 | _fi__(_AMD29K__) | |
5956 | _if__(_I960__) | |
5957 | @item target nindy @var{devicename} | |
5958 | @kindex target nindy | |
5959 | An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is | |
5960 | the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g. | |
5961 | @file{/dev/ttya}. @xref{i960-Nindy Remote}. | |
5962 | ||
5963 | _fi__(_I960__) | |
5964 | _if__(_VXWORKS__) | |
5965 | @item target vxworks @var{machinename} | |
5966 | @kindex target vxworks | |
5967 | A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename} | |
5968 | is the target system's machine name or IP address. | |
5969 | @xref{VxWorks Remote}. | |
5970 | _fi__(_VXWORKS__) | |
5971 | @end table | |
5972 | ||
5973 | _if__(_GENERIC__) | |
5974 | Different targets are available on different configurations of _GDBN__; your | |
5975 | configuration may have more or fewer targets. | |
5976 | _fi__(_GENERIC__) | |
5977 | ||
5978 | @node Remote, , Target Commands, Targets | |
5979 | @section Remote Debugging | |
5980 | @cindex remote debugging | |
5981 | ||
5982 | _if__(_GENERIC__) | |
5983 | @menu | |
5984 | _include__(gdbinv-m.m4)<>_dnl__ | |
5985 | @end menu | |
5986 | _fi__(_GENERIC__) | |
5987 | ||
5988 | If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that can't run | |
5989 | _GDBN__ in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging. For | |
5990 | example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel, or on | |
5991 | a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system | |
5992 | powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger. | |
5993 | ||
5994 | Some configurations of _GDBN__ have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces | |
5995 | to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition, | |
5996 | _GDBN__ comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to _GDBN__, but | |
5997 | not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you | |
5998 | write the remote stubs---the code that will run on the remote system to | |
5999 | communicate with _GDBN__. | |
6000 | ||
6001 | To use the _GDBN__ remote serial protocol, the program to be debugged on | |
6002 | the remote machine needs to contain a debugging stub which talks to | |
6003 | _GDBN__ over the serial line. Several working remote stubs are | |
6004 | distributed with _GDBN__; see the @file{README} file in the _GDBN__ | |
6005 | distribution for more information. | |
6006 | ||
6007 | For details of this communication protocol, see the comments in the | |
6008 | _GDBN__ source file @file{remote.c}. | |
6009 | ||
6010 | To start remote debugging, first run _GDBN__ and specify as an executable file | |
6011 | the program that is running in the remote machine. This tells _GDBN__ how | |
6012 | to find the program's symbols and the contents of its pure text. Then | |
6013 | establish communication using the @code{target remote} command with a device | |
6014 | name as an argument. For example: | |
6015 | ||
6016 | @example | |
6017 | target remote /dev/ttyb | |
6018 | @end example | |
6019 | ||
6020 | @noindent | |
6021 | if the serial line is connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}. This | |
6022 | will stop the remote machine if it is not already stopped. | |
6023 | ||
6024 | Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to | |
6025 | step and continue the remote program. | |
6026 | ||
6027 | To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach} | |
6028 | command. | |
6029 | ||
6030 | Other remote targets may be available in your | |
6031 | configuration of _GDBN__; use @code{help targets} to list them. | |
6032 | ||
6033 | _if__(_GENERIC__) | |
6034 | @c Text on starting up GDB in various specific cases; it goes up front | |
6035 | @c in manuals configured for any of those particular situations, here | |
6036 | @c otherwise. | |
6037 | _include__(gdbinv-s.m4) | |
6038 | _fi__(_GENERIC__) | |
6039 | ||
6040 | @node Controlling _GDBN__, Sequences, Targets, Top | |
6041 | @chapter Controlling _GDBN__ | |
6042 | ||
6043 | You can alter many aspects of _GDBN__'s interaction with you by using | |
6044 | the @code{set} command. For commands controlling how _GDBN__ displays | |
6045 | data, @pxref{Print Settings}; other settings are described here. | |
6046 | ||
6047 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
6048 | * Prompt:: Prompt |
6049 | * Editing:: Command Editing | |
6050 | * History:: Command History | |
6051 | * Screen Size:: Screen Size | |
6052 | * Numbers:: Numbers | |
6053 | * Messages/Warnings:: Optional Warnings and Messages | |
70b88761 RP |
6054 | @end menu |
6055 | ||
6056 | @node Prompt, Editing, Controlling _GDBN__, Controlling _GDBN__ | |
6057 | @section Prompt | |
6058 | @cindex prompt | |
6059 | _GDBN__ indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string | |
6060 | called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(_GDBP__)}. You | |
6061 | can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For | |
6062 | instance, when debugging _GDBN__ with _GDBN__, it is useful to change | |
6063 | the prompt in one of the _GDBN__<>s so that you can always tell which | |
6064 | one you are talking to. | |
6065 | ||
6066 | @table @code | |
6067 | @item set prompt @var{newprompt} | |
6068 | @kindex set prompt | |
6069 | Directs _GDBN__ to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth. | |
6070 | @kindex show prompt | |
6071 | @item show prompt | |
6072 | Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}} | |
6073 | @end table | |
6074 | ||
6075 | @node Editing, History, Prompt, Controlling _GDBN__ | |
6076 | @section Command Editing | |
6077 | @cindex readline | |
6078 | @cindex command line editing | |
6079 | _GDBN__ reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This | |
6080 | GNU library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a | |
6081 | command line interface to the user. Advantages are @code{emacs}-style | |
6082 | or @code{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history | |
6083 | substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across | |
6084 | debugging sessions. | |
6085 | ||
6086 | You may control the behavior of command line editing in _GDBN__ with the | |
6087 | command @code{set}. | |
6088 | ||
6089 | @table @code | |
6090 | @kindex set editing | |
6091 | @cindex editing | |
6092 | @item set editing | |
6093 | @itemx set editing on | |
6094 | Enable command line editing (enabled by default). | |
6095 | ||
6096 | @item set editing off | |
6097 | Disable command line editing. | |
6098 | ||
6099 | @kindex show editing | |
6100 | @item show editing | |
6101 | Show whether command line editing is enabled. | |
6102 | @end table | |
6103 | ||
6104 | @node History, Screen Size, Editing, Controlling _GDBN__ | |
6105 | @section Command History | |
6106 | @table @code | |
6107 | @cindex history substitution | |
6108 | @cindex history file | |
6109 | @kindex set history filename | |
6110 | @item set history filename @var{fname} | |
6111 | Set the name of the _GDBN__ command history file to @var{fname}. This is | |
6112 | the file from which _GDBN__ will read an initial command history | |
6113 | list or to which it will write this list when it exits. This list is | |
6114 | accessed through history expansion or through the history | |
6115 | command editing characters listed below. This file defaults to the | |
6116 | value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to | |
6117 | @file{./.gdb_history} if this variable is not set. | |
6118 | ||
6119 | @cindex history save | |
6120 | @kindex set history save | |
6121 | @item set history save | |
6122 | @itemx set history save on | |
6123 | Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the | |
6124 | @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled. | |
6125 | ||
6126 | @item set history save off | |
6127 | Stop recording command history in a file. | |
6128 | ||
6129 | @cindex history size | |
6130 | @kindex set history size | |
6131 | @item set history size @var{size} | |
6132 | Set the number of commands which _GDBN__ will keep in its history list. | |
6133 | This defaults to the value of the environment variable | |
6134 | @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. | |
6135 | @end table | |
6136 | ||
6137 | @cindex history expansion | |
6138 | History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}. | |
6139 | @iftex | |
6140 | (@xref{Event Designators}.) | |
6141 | @end iftex | |
6142 | Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion | |
6143 | is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the | |
6144 | @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to | |
6145 | follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with | |
6146 | a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline | |
6147 | history facilities will not attempt substitution on the strings | |
6148 | @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled. | |
6149 | ||
6150 | The commands to control history expansion are: | |
6151 | ||
6152 | @table @code | |
6153 | ||
6154 | @kindex set history expansion | |
6155 | @item set history expansion on | |
6156 | @itemx set history expansion | |
6157 | Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default. | |
6158 | ||
6159 | @item set history expansion off | |
6160 | Disable history expansion. | |
6161 | ||
6162 | The readline code comes with more complete documentation of | |
6163 | editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @code{emacs} | |
6164 | or @code{vi} may wish to read it. | |
6165 | @iftex | |
6166 | @xref{Command Line Editing}. | |
6167 | @end iftex | |
6168 | ||
6169 | @c @group | |
6170 | @kindex show history | |
6171 | @item show history | |
6172 | @itemx show history filename | |
6173 | @itemx show history save | |
6174 | @itemx show history size | |
6175 | @itemx show history expansion | |
6176 | These commands display the state of the _GDBN__ history parameters. | |
6177 | @code{show history} by itself displays all four states. | |
6178 | @c @end group | |
6179 | ||
6180 | @end table | |
6181 | ||
6182 | @table @code | |
6183 | @kindex show commands | |
6184 | @item show commands | |
6185 | Display the last ten commands in the command history. | |
6186 | ||
6187 | @item show commands @var{n} | |
6188 | Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}. | |
6189 | ||
6190 | @item show commands + | |
6191 | Print ten commands just after the commands last printed. | |
6192 | ||
6193 | @end table | |
6194 | ||
6195 | @node Screen Size, Numbers, History, Controlling _GDBN__ | |
6196 | @section Screen Size | |
6197 | @cindex size of screen | |
6198 | @cindex pauses in output | |
6199 | Certain commands to _GDBN__ may produce large amounts of information | |
6200 | output to the screen. To help you read all of it, _GDBN__ pauses and | |
6201 | asks you for input at the end of each page of output. Type @key{RET} | |
6202 | when you want to continue the output. _GDBN__ also uses the screen | |
6203 | width setting to determine when to wrap lines of output. Depending on | |
6204 | what is being printed, it tries to break the line at a readable place, | |
6205 | rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line. | |
6206 | ||
6207 | Normally _GDBN__ knows the size of the screen from the termcap data base | |
6208 | together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the | |
6209 | @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct, | |
6210 | you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set | |
6211 | width} commands: | |
6212 | ||
6213 | @table @code | |
6214 | @item set height @var{lpp} | |
6215 | @itemx show height | |
6216 | @itemx set width @var{cpl} | |
6217 | @itemx show width | |
6218 | @kindex set height | |
6219 | @kindex set width | |
6220 | @kindex show width | |
6221 | @kindex show height | |
6222 | These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and | |
6223 | a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show} | |
6224 | commands display the current settings. | |
6225 | ||
6226 | If you specify a height of zero lines, _GDBN__ will not pause during output | |
6227 | no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a file | |
6228 | or to an editor buffer. | |
6229 | @end table | |
6230 | ||
6231 | @node Numbers, Messages/Warnings, Screen Size, Controlling _GDBN__ | |
6232 | @section Numbers | |
6233 | @cindex number representation | |
6234 | @cindex entering numbers | |
6235 | You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in _GDBN__ by | |
6236 | the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with @samp{0}, decimal | |
6237 | numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers begin with @samp{0x}. | |
6238 | Numbers that begin with none of these are, by default, entered in base | |
6239 | 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular | |
6240 | format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for | |
6241 | both input and output with the @code{set radix} command. | |
6242 | ||
6243 | @table @code | |
6244 | @kindex set radix | |
6245 | @item set radix @var{base} | |
6246 | Set the default base for numeric input and display. Supported choices | |
c2bbbb22 | 6247 | for @var{base} are decimal 2, 8, 10, 16. @var{base} must itself be |
70b88761 RP |
6248 | specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for |
6249 | example, any of | |
6250 | ||
6251 | @example | |
c2bbbb22 | 6252 | set radix 1010 |
70b88761 RP |
6253 | set radix 012 |
6254 | set radix 10. | |
6255 | set radix 0xa | |
6256 | @end example | |
6257 | ||
6258 | @noindent | |
6259 | will set the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10} | |
6260 | will leave the radix unchanged no matter what it was. | |
6261 | ||
6262 | @kindex show radix | |
6263 | @item show radix | |
6264 | Display the current default base for numeric input and display. | |
6265 | ||
6266 | @end table | |
6267 | ||
c2bbbb22 | 6268 | @node Messages/Warnings, , Numbers, Controlling _GDBN__ |
70b88761 RP |
6269 | @section Optional Warnings and Messages |
6270 | By default, _GDBN__ is silent about its inner workings. If you are running | |
6271 | on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose} command. | |
6272 | It will make _GDBN__ tell you when it does a lengthy internal operation, so | |
6273 | you won't think it has crashed. | |
6274 | ||
6275 | Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those which | |
6276 | announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read | |
6277 | (@pxref{Files}, in the description of the command | |
6278 | @code{symbol-file}). | |
6279 | @c The following is the right way to do it, but emacs 18.55 doesn't support | |
6280 | @c @ref, and neither the emacs lisp manual version of texinfmt or makeinfo | |
6281 | @c is released. | |
6282 | @ignore | |
6283 | see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files}). | |
6284 | @end ignore | |
6285 | ||
6286 | @table @code | |
6287 | @kindex set verbose | |
6288 | @item set verbose on | |
6289 | Enables _GDBN__'s output of certain informational messages. | |
6290 | ||
6291 | @item set verbose off | |
6292 | Disables _GDBN__'s output of certain informational messages. | |
6293 | ||
6294 | @kindex show verbose | |
6295 | @item show verbose | |
6296 | Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off. | |
6297 | @end table | |
6298 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
6299 | By default, if _GDBN__ encounters bugs in the symbol table of an object |
6300 | file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may find | |
6301 | this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors}). | |
70b88761 RP |
6302 | |
6303 | @table @code | |
6304 | @kindex set complaints | |
6305 | @item set complaints @var{limit} | |
6306 | Permits _GDBN__ to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of unusual | |
6307 | symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set @var{limit} to | |
6308 | zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number to prevent | |
6309 | complaints from being suppressed. | |
6310 | ||
6311 | @kindex show complaints | |
6312 | @item show complaints | |
6313 | Displays how many symbol complaints _GDBN__ is permitted to produce. | |
6314 | @end table | |
6315 | ||
6316 | By default, _GDBN__ is cautious, and asks what sometimes seem to be a | |
6317 | lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if | |
6318 | you try to run a program which is already running: | |
6319 | @example | |
6320 | (_GDBP__) run | |
6321 | The program being debugged has been started already. | |
6322 | Start it from the beginning? (y or n) | |
6323 | @end example | |
6324 | ||
6325 | If you're willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own | |
6326 | commands, you can disable this ``feature'': | |
6327 | ||
6328 | @table @code | |
6329 | @kindex set confirm | |
6330 | @cindex flinching | |
6331 | @cindex confirmation | |
6332 | @cindex stupid questions | |
6333 | @item set confirm off | |
6334 | Disables confirmation requests. | |
6335 | ||
6336 | @item set confirm on | |
6337 | Enables confirmation requests (the default). | |
6338 | ||
6339 | @item show confirm | |
6340 | @kindex show confirm | |
6341 | Displays state of confirmation requests. | |
6342 | @end table | |
6343 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
6344 | @c FIXME this doesn't really belong here. But where *does* it belong? |
6345 | @cindex reloading symbols | |
6346 | Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to | |
6347 | be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. | |
6348 | _if__(_VXWORKS__) | |
6349 | For example, in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file | |
6350 | and keep on running. | |
6351 | _fi__(_VXWORKS__) | |
6352 | If you're running on one of these systems, you can allow _GDBN__ to | |
6353 | reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:@refill | |
6354 | @table @code | |
6355 | @kindex set symbol-reloading | |
6356 | @item set symbol-reloading on | |
6357 | Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an | |
6358 | object file with a particular name is seen again. | |
6359 | ||
6360 | @item set symbol-reloading off | |
6361 | Don't replace symbol definitions when re-encountering object files of | |
6362 | the same name. This is the default state; if you're not running on a | |
6363 | system that permits automatically relinking modules, you should leave | |
6364 | @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise _GDBN__ may discard symbols | |
6365 | when linking large programs, that may contain several modules (from | |
6366 | different directories or libraries) with the same name. | |
6367 | ||
6368 | @item show symbol-reloading | |
6369 | Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting. | |
6370 | @end table | |
6371 | ||
70b88761 RP |
6372 | @node Sequences, Emacs, Controlling _GDBN__, Top |
6373 | @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands | |
6374 | ||
6375 | Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands}), _GDBN__ provides two | |
6376 | ways to store sequences of commands for execution as a unit: | |
6377 | user-defined commands and command files. | |
6378 | ||
6379 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
6380 | * Define:: User-Defined Commands |
6381 | * Command Files:: Command Files | |
6382 | * Output:: Commands for Controlled Output | |
70b88761 RP |
6383 | @end menu |
6384 | ||
6385 | @node Define, Command Files, Sequences, Sequences | |
6386 | @section User-Defined Commands | |
6387 | ||
6388 | @cindex user-defined command | |
6389 | A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of _GDBN__ commands to which you | |
6390 | assign a new name as a command. This is done with the @code{define} | |
6391 | command. | |
6392 | ||
6393 | @table @code | |
6394 | @item define @var{commandname} | |
6395 | @kindex define | |
6396 | Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command | |
6397 | by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it. | |
6398 | ||
6399 | The definition of the command is made up of other _GDBN__ command lines, | |
6400 | which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these | |
6401 | commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}. | |
6402 | ||
6403 | @item document @var{commandname} | |
6404 | @kindex document | |
6405 | Give documentation to the user-defined command @var{commandname}. The | |
6406 | command @var{commandname} must already be defined. This command reads | |
6407 | lines of documentation just as @code{define} reads the lines of the | |
6408 | command definition, ending with @code{end}. After the @code{document} | |
6409 | command is finished, @code{help} on command @var{commandname} will print | |
6410 | the documentation you have specified. | |
6411 | ||
6412 | You may use the @code{document} command again to change the | |
6413 | documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define} | |
6414 | does not change the documentation. | |
6415 | ||
6416 | @item help user-defined | |
6417 | @kindex help user-defined | |
6418 | List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation | |
6419 | (if any) for each. | |
6420 | ||
6421 | @item info user | |
6422 | @itemx info user @var{commandname} | |
6423 | @kindex info user | |
6424 | Display the _GDBN__ commands used to define @var{commandname} (but not its | |
6425 | documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the | |
6426 | definitions for all user-defined commands. | |
6427 | @end table | |
6428 | ||
6429 | User-defined commands do not take arguments. When they are executed, the | |
6430 | commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command | |
6431 | stops execution of the user-defined command. | |
6432 | ||
6433 | Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed | |
6434 | without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many _GDBN__ commands | |
6435 | that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages | |
6436 | when used in a user-defined command. | |
6437 | ||
6438 | @node Command Files, Output, Define, Sequences | |
6439 | @section Command Files | |
6440 | ||
6441 | @cindex command files | |
6442 | A command file for _GDBN__ is a file of lines that are _GDBN__ commands. Comments | |
6443 | (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included. An empty line in a | |
6444 | command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat the last command, as | |
6445 | it would from the terminal. | |
6446 | ||
6447 | @cindex init file | |
6448 | @cindex @file{_GDBINIT__} | |
6449 | When you start _GDBN__, it automatically executes commands from its | |
6450 | @dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{_GDBINIT__}. _GDBN__ | |
6451 | reads the init file (if any) in your home directory and then the init | |
6452 | file (if any) in the current working directory. (The init files are not | |
6453 | executed if you use the @samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options}.) You | |
6454 | can also request the execution of a command file with the @code{source} | |
6455 | command: | |
6456 | ||
6457 | @table @code | |
6458 | @item source @var{filename} | |
6459 | @kindex source | |
6460 | Execute the command file @var{filename}. | |
6461 | @end table | |
6462 | ||
6463 | The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not | |
6464 | printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution | |
6465 | of the command file. | |
6466 | ||
6467 | Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed | |
6468 | without asking when used in a command file. Many _GDBN__ commands that | |
6469 | normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages | |
6470 | when called from command files. | |
6471 | ||
6472 | @node Output, , Command Files, Sequences | |
6473 | @section Commands for Controlled Output | |
6474 | ||
6475 | During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal | |
6476 | _GDBN__ output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is | |
6477 | explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section | |
6478 | describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you | |
6479 | want. | |
6480 | ||
6481 | @table @code | |
6482 | @item echo @var{text} | |
6483 | @kindex echo | |
6484 | @c I don't consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence | |
6485 | @c because it's not in ANSI. | |
6486 | Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in @var{text} | |
6487 | using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a newline. @b{No | |
6488 | newline will be printed unless you specify one.} In addition to the | |
6489 | standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed by a space stands for a | |
6490 | space. This is useful for outputting a string with spaces at the | |
6491 | beginning or the end, since leading and trailing spaces are otherwise | |
6492 | trimmed from all arguments. Thus, to print @samp{@ and foo =@ }, use the | |
6493 | command @samp{echo \@ and foo = \@ }. | |
6494 | @c FIXME: verify hard copy actually issues enspaces for '@ '! Will this | |
6495 | @c confuse texinfo? | |
6496 | ||
6497 | A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue | |
6498 | the command onto subsequent lines. For example, | |
6499 | ||
6500 | @example | |
6501 | echo This is some text\n\ | |
6502 | which is continued\n\ | |
6503 | onto several lines.\n | |
6504 | @end example | |
6505 | ||
6506 | produces the same output as | |
6507 | ||
6508 | @example | |
6509 | echo This is some text\n | |
6510 | echo which is continued\n | |
6511 | echo onto several lines.\n | |
6512 | @end example | |
6513 | ||
6514 | @item output @var{expression} | |
6515 | @kindex output | |
6516 | Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no | |
6517 | newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the | |
6518 | value history either. @xref{Expressions} for more information on | |
6519 | expressions. | |
6520 | ||
6521 | @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression} | |
6522 | Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use | |
6523 | the same formats as for @code{print}; @pxref{Output formats}, for more | |
6524 | information. | |
6525 | ||
6526 | @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{} | |
6527 | @kindex printf | |
6528 | Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of | |
6529 | @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may | |
6530 | be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified | |
6531 | by @var{string}, exactly as if the program were to execute | |
6532 | ||
6533 | @example | |
6534 | printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}); | |
6535 | @end example | |
6536 | ||
6537 | For example, you can print two values in hex like this: | |
6538 | ||
6539 | @example | |
6540 | printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo | |
6541 | @end example | |
6542 | ||
6543 | The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format | |
6544 | string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a | |
6545 | letter. | |
6546 | @end table | |
6547 | ||
6548 | @node Emacs, _GDBN__ Bugs, Sequences, Top | |
6549 | @chapter Using _GDBN__ under GNU Emacs | |
6550 | ||
6551 | @cindex emacs | |
6552 | A special interface allows you to use GNU Emacs to view (and | |
6553 | edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with | |
6554 | _GDBN__. | |
6555 | ||
6556 | To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the | |
6557 | executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts | |
6558 | _GDBN__ as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly | |
6559 | created Emacs buffer. | |
6560 | ||
6561 | Using _GDBN__ under Emacs is just like using _GDBN__ normally except for two | |
6562 | things: | |
6563 | ||
6564 | @itemize @bullet | |
6565 | @item | |
6566 | All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer. | |
6567 | @end itemize | |
6568 | ||
6569 | This applies both to _GDBN__ commands and their output, and to the input | |
6570 | and output done by the program you are debugging. | |
6571 | ||
6572 | This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous | |
6573 | commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output | |
6574 | in this way. | |
6575 | ||
3d3ab540 RP |
6576 | All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting |
6577 | with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual | |
6578 | way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a | |
6579 | stop. | |
70b88761 RP |
6580 | |
6581 | @itemize @bullet | |
6582 | @item | |
6583 | _GDBN__ displays source code through Emacs. | |
6584 | @end itemize | |
6585 | ||
6586 | Each time _GDBN__ displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the | |
6587 | source file for that frame and puts an arrow (_0__@samp{=>}_1__) at the | |
6588 | left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for | |
6589 | source display, and splits the window to show both your _GDBN__ session | |
6590 | and the source. | |
6591 | ||
6592 | Explicit _GDBN__ @code{list} or search commands still produce output as | |
6593 | usual, but you probably will have no reason to use them. | |
6594 | ||
6595 | @quotation | |
6596 | @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your | |
6597 | current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of | |
6598 | the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer will not | |
6599 | appear to show your source. _GDBN__ can find programs by searching your | |
6600 | environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the _GDBN__ input and output | |
6601 | session will proceed normally; but Emacs doesn't get enough information | |
6602 | back from _GDBN__ to locate the source files in this situation. To | |
6603 | avoid this problem, either start _GDBN__ mode from the directory where | |
6604 | your program resides, or specify a full path name when prompted for the | |
6605 | @kbd{M-x gdb} argument. | |
6606 | ||
6607 | A similar confusion can result if you use the _GDBN__ @code{file} command to | |
6608 | switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing | |
6609 | _GDBN__ buffer in Emacs. | |
6610 | @end quotation | |
6611 | ||
6612 | By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If | |
6613 | you need to call _GDBN__ by a different name (for example, if you keep | |
6614 | several configurations around, with different names) you can set the | |
6615 | Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example, | |
6616 | @example | |
6617 | (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb") | |
6618 | @end example | |
6619 | @noindent | |
6620 | (preceded by @kbd{ESC ESC}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or | |
6621 | in your @file{.emacs} file) will make Emacs call the program named | |
6622 | ``@code{mygdb}'' instead. | |
6623 | ||
6624 | In the _GDBN__ I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in | |
6625 | addition to the standard Shell mode commands: | |
6626 | ||
6627 | @table @kbd | |
6628 | @item C-h m | |
6629 | Describe the features of Emacs' _GDBN__ Mode. | |
6630 | ||
6631 | @item M-s | |
6632 | Execute to another source line, like the _GDBN__ @code{step} command; also | |
6633 | update the display window to show the current file and location. | |
6634 | ||
6635 | @item M-n | |
6636 | Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function | |
6637 | calls, like the _GDBN__ @code{next} command. Then update the display window | |
6638 | to show the current file and location. | |
6639 | ||
6640 | @item M-i | |
6641 | Execute one instruction, like the _GDBN__ @code{stepi} command; update | |
6642 | display window accordingly. | |
6643 | ||
6644 | @item M-x gdb-nexti | |
6645 | Execute to next instruction, using the _GDBN__ @code{nexti} command; update | |
6646 | display window accordingly. | |
6647 | ||
6648 | @item C-c C-f | |
6649 | Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the _GDBN__ | |
6650 | @code{finish} command. | |
6651 | ||
6652 | @item M-c | |
6653 | Continue execution of the program, like the _GDBN__ @code{continue} | |
6654 | command. @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}. | |
6655 | ||
6656 | @item M-u | |
6657 | Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument | |
6658 | (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}), | |
6659 | like the _GDBN__ @code{up} command. @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this | |
6660 | command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.@refill | |
6661 | ||
6662 | @item M-d | |
6663 | Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the | |
6664 | _GDBN__ @code{down} command. @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command | |
6665 | is @kbd{C-c C-d}. | |
6666 | ||
6667 | @item C-x & | |
6668 | Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end | |
6669 | of the _GDBN__ I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code | |
6670 | around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble}; | |
6671 | then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the | |
6672 | argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}. | |
6673 | ||
6674 | You can customize this further on the fly by defining elements of the list | |
6675 | @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or | |
6676 | otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are | |
c2bbbb22 | 6677 | inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} will both indicate that you |
70b88761 RP |
6678 | wish special formatting, and act as an index to pick an element of the |
6679 | list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is | |
6680 | formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number | |
6681 | is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element. | |
6682 | ||
6683 | @end table | |
6684 | ||
6685 | In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break}) | |
6686 | tells _GDBN__ to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on. | |
6687 | ||
6688 | If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get | |
6689 | it back is to type the command @code{f} in the _GDBN__ buffer, to | |
6690 | request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this will recreate | |
6691 | the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current | |
6692 | frame. | |
6693 | ||
6694 | The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers | |
6695 | which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit | |
6696 | the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that _GDBN__ | |
6697 | communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or | |
6698 | delete lines from the text, the line numbers that _GDBN__ knows will cease | |
6699 | to correspond properly to the code. | |
6700 | ||
6701 | @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate | |
6702 | @c if/when v19 does something similar. [email protected] 19dec1990 | |
6703 | @ignore | |
6704 | @kindex emacs epoch environment | |
6705 | @kindex epoch | |
6706 | @kindex inspect | |
6707 | ||
6708 | Version 18 of Emacs has a built-in window system called the @code{epoch} | |
6709 | environment. Users of this environment can use a new command, | |
6710 | @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that | |
6711 | each value is printed in its own window. | |
6712 | @end ignore | |
6713 | ||
6714 | @node _GDBN__ Bugs, Renamed Commands, Emacs, Top | |
6715 | @chapter Reporting Bugs in _GDBN__ | |
6716 | @cindex Bugs in _GDBN__ | |
6717 | @cindex Reporting Bugs in _GDBN__ | |
6718 | ||
6719 | Your bug reports play an essential role in making _GDBN__ reliable. | |
6720 | ||
6721 | Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it | |
6722 | may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help | |
6723 | the entire community by making the next version of _GDBN__ work better. Bug | |
6724 | reports are your contribution to the maintenance of _GDBN__. | |
6725 | ||
6726 | In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the | |
6727 | information that enables us to fix the bug. | |
6728 | ||
6729 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
6730 | * Bug Criteria:: Have You Found a Bug? |
6731 | * Bug Reporting:: How to Report Bugs | |
70b88761 RP |
6732 | @end menu |
6733 | ||
6734 | @node Bug Criteria, Bug Reporting, _GDBN__ Bugs, _GDBN__ Bugs | |
6735 | @section Have You Found a Bug? | |
6736 | @cindex Bug Criteria | |
6737 | ||
6738 | If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines: | |
6739 | ||
6740 | @itemize @bullet | |
6741 | @item | |
6742 | @cindex Fatal Signal | |
6743 | @cindex Core Dump | |
6744 | If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a | |
6745 | _GDBN__ bug. Reliable debuggers never crash. | |
6746 | ||
6747 | @item | |
6748 | @cindex error on Valid Input | |
6749 | If _GDBN__ produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug. | |
6750 | ||
6751 | @item | |
6752 | @cindex Invalid Input | |
6753 | If _GDBN__ does not produce an error message for invalid input, | |
6754 | that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of | |
6755 | ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support | |
6756 | for traditional practice''. | |
6757 | ||
6758 | @item | |
6759 | If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions | |
6760 | for improvement of _GDBN__ are welcome in any case. | |
6761 | @end itemize | |
6762 | ||
6763 | @node Bug Reporting, , Bug Criteria, _GDBN__ Bugs | |
6764 | @section How to Report Bugs | |
6765 | @cindex Bug Reports | |
3d3ab540 | 6766 | @cindex _GDBN__ Bugs, Reporting |
70b88761 RP |
6767 | |
6768 | A number of companies and individuals offer support for GNU products. | |
6769 | If you obtained _GDBN__ from a support organization, we recommend you | |
6770 | contact that organization first. | |
6771 | ||
6772 | Contact information for many support companies and individuals is | |
6773 | available in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the GNU Emacs distribution. | |
6774 | ||
6775 | In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for _GDBN__ to one | |
6776 | of these addresses: | |
6777 | ||
6778 | @example | |
6779 | bug-gdb@@prep.ai.mit.edu | |
6780 | @{ucbvax|mit-eddie|uunet@}!prep.ai.mit.edu!bug-gdb | |
6781 | @end example | |
6782 | ||
6783 | @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to | |
6784 | @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of _GDBN__ do not want to | |
6785 | receive bug reports. Those that do, have arranged to receive @samp{bug-gdb}. | |
6786 | ||
3d3ab540 RP |
6787 | The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which |
6788 | serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly | |
6789 | the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the | |
6790 | newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one | |
6791 | problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail | |
6792 | path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information, | |
6793 | we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send | |
6794 | bug reports to the mailing list. | |
70b88761 RP |
6795 | |
6796 | As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to: | |
6797 | ||
6798 | @example | |
6799 | GNU Debugger Bugs | |
3d3ab540 | 6800 | Free Software Foundation |
70b88761 RP |
6801 | 545 Tech Square |
6802 | Cambridge, MA 02139 | |
6803 | @end example | |
6804 | ||
6805 | The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this: | |
6806 | @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a | |
6807 | fact or leave it out, state it! | |
6808 | ||
6809 | Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the | |
6810 | problem and assume that some details don't matter. Thus, you might | |
6811 | assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter. | |
6812 | Well, probably it doesn't, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a | |
6813 | stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that | |
6814 | name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents | |
6815 | of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite | |
6816 | the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the | |
6817 | easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful. | |
6818 | ||
6819 | Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix | |
6820 | the bug if it is new to us. It isn't as important what happens if | |
6821 | the bug is already known. Therefore, always write your bug reports on | |
6822 | the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously. | |
6823 | ||
6824 | Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a | |
6825 | bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to | |
6826 | @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report | |
6827 | bugs properly. | |
6828 | ||
6829 | To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things: | |
6830 | ||
6831 | @itemize @bullet | |
6832 | @item | |
6833 | The version of _GDBN__. _GDBN__ announces it if you start with no | |
6834 | arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show version}. | |
6835 | ||
6836 | Without this, we won't know whether there is any point in looking for | |
6837 | the bug in the current version of _GDBN__. | |
6838 | ||
6839 | @item | |
6840 | A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will | |
6841 | reproduce the bug. | |
6842 | ||
6843 | @item | |
6844 | What compiler (and its version) was used to compile _GDBN__---e.g. | |
6845 | ``_GCC__-1.37.1''. | |
6846 | ||
6847 | @item | |
6848 | The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and | |
6849 | observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee | |
6850 | you won't omit something important, list them all. | |
6851 | ||
6852 | If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong | |
6853 | and then we might not encounter the bug. | |
6854 | ||
6855 | @item | |
6856 | The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and | |
6857 | version number. | |
6858 | ||
6859 | @item | |
6860 | A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is | |
6861 | incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.'' | |
6862 | ||
6863 | Of course, if the bug is that _GDBN__ gets a fatal signal, then we will | |
6864 | certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might not | |
6865 | notice unless it is glaringly wrong. We are human, after all. You | |
6866 | might as well not give us a chance to make a mistake. | |
6867 | ||
6868 | Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still | |
6869 | say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, | |
6870 | your copy of _GDBN__ is out of synch, or you have encountered a | |
6871 | bug in the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy | |
6872 | might crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, | |
6873 | then when ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not | |
6874 | happening for us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we | |
6875 | would not be able to draw any conclusion from our observations. | |
6876 | ||
6877 | @item | |
6878 | If you wish to suggest changes to the _GDBN__ source, send us context | |
6879 | diffs. If you even discuss something in the _GDBN__ source, refer to | |
6880 | it by context, not by line number. | |
6881 | ||
6882 | The line numbers in our development sources won't match those in your | |
6883 | sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us. | |
6884 | ||
6885 | @end itemize | |
6886 | ||
6887 | Here are some things that are not necessary: | |
6888 | ||
6889 | @itemize @bullet | |
6890 | @item | |
6891 | A description of the envelope of the bug. | |
6892 | ||
6893 | Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating | |
6894 | which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which | |
6895 | changes will not affect it. | |
6896 | ||
6897 | This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we | |
6898 | will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger | |
6899 | with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples. | |
6900 | We recommend that you save your time for something else. | |
6901 | ||
6902 | Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead} | |
6903 | of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the | |
6904 | output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take | |
6905 | less time, etc. | |
6906 | ||
6907 | However, simplification is not vital; if you don't want to do this, | |
6908 | report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used. | |
6909 | ||
6910 | @item | |
6911 | A patch for the bug. | |
6912 | ||
6913 | A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But don't omit | |
6914 | the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that | |
6915 | a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide | |
6916 | to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all. | |
6917 | ||
6918 | Sometimes with a program as complicated as _GDBN__ it is very hard to | |
6919 | construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path | |
6920 | through the code. If you don't send us the example, we won't be able | |
6921 | to construct one, so we won't be able to verify that the bug is fixed. | |
6922 | ||
6923 | And if we can't understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your | |
6924 | patch should be an improvement, we won't install it. A test case will | |
6925 | help us to understand. | |
6926 | ||
6927 | @item | |
6928 | A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on. | |
6929 | ||
6930 | Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we can't guess right about such | |
6931 | things without first using the debugger to find the facts. | |
6932 | @end itemize | |
6933 | ||
6934 | @iftex | |
b80282d5 | 6935 | @include rdl-apps.texi |
70b88761 RP |
6936 | @end iftex |
6937 | ||
6938 | @node Renamed Commands, Installing _GDBN__, _GDBN__ Bugs, Top | |
6939 | @appendix Renamed Commands | |
6940 | ||
6941 | The following commands were renamed in _GDBN__ 4.0, in order to make the | |
6942 | command set as a whole more consistent and easier to use and remember: | |
6943 | ||
6944 | @kindex add-syms | |
6945 | @kindex delete environment | |
6946 | @kindex info copying | |
6947 | @kindex info convenience | |
6948 | @kindex info directories | |
6949 | @kindex info editing | |
6950 | @kindex info history | |
6951 | @kindex info targets | |
6952 | @kindex info values | |
6953 | @kindex info version | |
6954 | @kindex info warranty | |
6955 | @kindex set addressprint | |
6956 | @kindex set arrayprint | |
6957 | @kindex set prettyprint | |
6958 | @kindex set screen-height | |
6959 | @kindex set screen-width | |
6960 | @kindex set unionprint | |
6961 | @kindex set vtblprint | |
6962 | @kindex set demangle | |
6963 | @kindex set asm-demangle | |
6964 | @kindex set sevenbit-strings | |
6965 | @kindex set array-max | |
6966 | @kindex set caution | |
6967 | @kindex set history write | |
6968 | @kindex show addressprint | |
6969 | @kindex show arrayprint | |
6970 | @kindex show prettyprint | |
6971 | @kindex show screen-height | |
6972 | @kindex show screen-width | |
6973 | @kindex show unionprint | |
6974 | @kindex show vtblprint | |
6975 | @kindex show demangle | |
6976 | @kindex show asm-demangle | |
6977 | @kindex show sevenbit-strings | |
6978 | @kindex show array-max | |
6979 | @kindex show caution | |
6980 | @kindex show history write | |
6981 | @kindex unset | |
6982 | ||
6983 | @ifinfo | |
cf496415 RP |
6984 | @example |
6985 | OLD COMMAND NEW COMMAND | |
6986 | --------------- ------------------------------- | |
6987 | add-syms add-symbol-file | |
6988 | delete environment unset environment | |
6989 | info convenience show convenience | |
6990 | info copying show copying | |
6991 | info directories show directories | |
6992 | info editing show commands | |
6993 | info history show values | |
6994 | info targets help target | |
6995 | info values show values | |
6996 | info version show version | |
6997 | info warranty show warranty | |
6998 | set/show addressprint set/show print address | |
6999 | set/show array-max set/show print elements | |
7000 | set/show arrayprint set/show print array | |
7001 | set/show asm-demangle set/show print asm-demangle | |
7002 | set/show caution set/show confirm | |
7003 | set/show demangle set/show print demangle | |
7004 | set/show history write set/show history save | |
7005 | set/show prettyprint set/show print pretty | |
7006 | set/show screen-height set/show height | |
7007 | set/show screen-width set/show width | |
7008 | set/show sevenbit-strings set/show print sevenbit-strings | |
7009 | set/show unionprint set/show print union | |
7010 | set/show vtblprint set/show print vtbl | |
7011 | ||
7012 | unset [No longer an alias for delete] | |
7013 | @end example | |
70b88761 RP |
7014 | @end ifinfo |
7015 | ||
7016 | @tex | |
7017 | \vskip \parskip\vskip \baselineskip | |
7018 | \halign{\tt #\hfil &\qquad#&\tt #\hfil\cr | |
7019 | {\bf Old Command} &&{\bf New Command}\cr | |
7020 | add-syms &&add-symbol-file\cr | |
7021 | delete environment &&unset environment\cr | |
7022 | info convenience &&show convenience\cr | |
7023 | info copying &&show copying\cr | |
7024 | info directories &&show directories \cr | |
7025 | info editing &&show commands\cr | |
7026 | info history &&show values\cr | |
7027 | info targets &&help target\cr | |
7028 | info values &&show values\cr | |
7029 | info version &&show version\cr | |
7030 | info warranty &&show warranty\cr | |
7031 | set{\rm / }show addressprint &&set{\rm / }show print address\cr | |
7032 | set{\rm / }show array-max &&set{\rm / }show print elements\cr | |
7033 | set{\rm / }show arrayprint &&set{\rm / }show print array\cr | |
7034 | set{\rm / }show asm-demangle &&set{\rm / }show print asm-demangle\cr | |
7035 | set{\rm / }show caution &&set{\rm / }show confirm\cr | |
7036 | set{\rm / }show demangle &&set{\rm / }show print demangle\cr | |
7037 | set{\rm / }show history write &&set{\rm / }show history save\cr | |
7038 | set{\rm / }show prettyprint &&set{\rm / }show print pretty\cr | |
7039 | set{\rm / }show screen-height &&set{\rm / }show height\cr | |
7040 | set{\rm / }show screen-width &&set{\rm / }show width\cr | |
7041 | set{\rm / }show sevenbit-strings &&set{\rm / }show print sevenbit-strings\cr | |
7042 | set{\rm / }show unionprint &&set{\rm / }show print union\cr | |
7043 | set{\rm / }show vtblprint &&set{\rm / }show print vtbl\cr | |
7044 | \cr | |
7045 | unset &&\rm(No longer an alias for delete)\cr | |
7046 | } | |
7047 | @end tex | |
7048 | ||
7049 | @node Installing _GDBN__, Copying, Renamed Commands, Top | |
7050 | @appendix Installing _GDBN__ | |
7051 | @cindex configuring _GDBN__ | |
7052 | @cindex installation | |
7053 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
7054 | _GDBN__ comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process |
7055 | of preparing _GDBN__ for installation; you can then use @code{make} to | |
7056 | build the @code{_GDBP__} program. | |
7057 | ||
7058 | The _GDBP__ distribution includes all the source code you need for | |
3e0d0a27 | 7059 | _GDBP__ in a single directory @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__}. That directory in turn |
b80282d5 RP |
7060 | contains: |
7061 | ||
3d3ab540 | 7062 | @table @code |
3e0d0a27 | 7063 | @item gdb-_GDB_VN__/configure |
b80282d5 RP |
7064 | Overall script for configuring _GDBN__ and all its supporting libraries. |
7065 | ||
3e0d0a27 | 7066 | @item gdb-_GDB_VN__/gdb |
3d3ab540 RP |
7067 | the source specific to _GDBN__ itself |
7068 | ||
3e0d0a27 | 7069 | @item gdb-_GDB_VN__/bfd |
3d3ab540 RP |
7070 | source for the Binary File Descriptor Library |
7071 | ||
3e0d0a27 | 7072 | @item gdb-_GDB_VN__/include |
b80282d5 | 7073 | GNU include files |
3d3ab540 | 7074 | |
3e0d0a27 | 7075 | @item gdb-_GDB_VN__/libiberty |
3d3ab540 RP |
7076 | source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library |
7077 | ||
3e0d0a27 | 7078 | @item gdb-_GDB_VN__/readline |
b80282d5 | 7079 | source for the GNU command-line interface |
3d3ab540 | 7080 | @end table |
7463aadd | 7081 | @noindent |
b80282d5 | 7082 | Each of these directories has its own @code{configure} script, which are |
3e0d0a27 | 7083 | used by the overall @code{configure} script in @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__}. |
7463aadd | 7084 | |
3e0d0a27 | 7085 | It is most convenient to run @code{configure} from the @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__} |
b80282d5 RP |
7086 | directory. The simplest way to configure and build _GDBN__ is the |
7087 | following: | |
7463aadd | 7088 | @example |
3e0d0a27 | 7089 | cd gdb-_GDB_VN__ |
3d3ab540 | 7090 | ./configure @var{host} |
7463aadd RP |
7091 | make |
7092 | @end example | |
7093 | @noindent | |
b80282d5 | 7094 | where @var{host} is something like @samp{sun4} or @samp{decstation}, that |
3d3ab540 RP |
7095 | identifies the platform where _GDBN__ will run. This builds the three |
7096 | libraries @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and @file{libiberty}, then | |
7097 | @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the binaries, are | |
7098 | left in the corresponding source directories. | |
7099 | ||
7100 | You can install @code{_GDBP__} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths. However, | |
7101 | you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by the | |
7102 | @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable; some systems | |
7103 | refuse to let _GDBN__ debug child processes whose programs are not | |
7104 | readable, and _GDBN__ uses the shell to start your program. | |
7105 | ||
7106 | @menu | |
b80282d5 RP |
7107 | * Subdirectories:: Configuration subdirectories |
7108 | * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets | |
7109 | * configure Options:: Summary of options for configure | |
c2bbbb22 | 7110 | * Formatting Manual:: How to format and print _GDBN__ documentation |
3d3ab540 RP |
7111 | @end menu |
7112 | ||
7113 | ||
b80282d5 | 7114 | @node Subdirectories, Config Names, Installing _GDBN__, Installing _GDBN__ |
3d3ab540 | 7115 | @section Configuration Subdirectories |
b80282d5 RP |
7116 | If you want to run _GDBN__ versions for several host or target machines, |
7117 | you'll need a different _GDBP__ compiled for each combination of host | |
7118 | and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by allowing | |
7119 | you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory. If your | |
7120 | @code{make} program handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (GNU @code{make} | |
7121 | does), running @code{make} in each of these directories then builds the | |
7122 | _GDBP__ program specified there. | |
7123 | ||
7124 | @code{configure} creates these subdirectories for you when you | |
7125 | simultaneously specify several configurations; but it's a good habit | |
7126 | even for a single configuration. You can specify the use of | |
7127 | subdirectories using the @samp{+subdirs} option (abbreviated | |
7128 | @samp{+sub}). For example, you can build _GDBN__ on a Sun 4 as follows: | |
70b88761 RP |
7129 | |
7130 | @example | |
3d3ab540 | 7131 | @group |
3e0d0a27 | 7132 | cd gdb-_GDB_VN__ |
b80282d5 RP |
7133 | ./configure +sub sun4 |
7134 | cd Host-sparc-sun-sunos4/Target-sparc-sun-sunos4 | |
70b88761 | 7135 | make |
3d3ab540 | 7136 | @end group |
70b88761 RP |
7137 | @end example |
7138 | ||
3d3ab540 RP |
7139 | When @code{configure} uses subdirectories to build programs or |
7140 | libraries, it creates nested directories | |
b80282d5 RP |
7141 | @file{Host-@var{host}/Target-@var{target}}. (As you see in the example, |
7142 | the names used for @var{host} and @var{target} may be expanded from your | |
7143 | @code{configure} argument; @pxref{Config Names}). @code{configure} uses | |
7144 | these two directory levels because _GDBN__ can be configured for | |
7145 | cross-compiling: _GDBN__ can run on one machine (the host) while | |
7146 | debugging programs that run on another machine (the target). You | |
7147 | specify cross-debugging targets by giving the | |
7148 | @samp{+target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}. Specifying only | |
7149 | hosts still gives you two levels of subdirectory for each host, with the | |
7150 | same configuration suffix on both; that is, if you give any number of | |
7151 | hosts but no targets, _GDBN__ will be configured for native debugging on | |
7152 | each host. On the other hand, whenever you specify both hosts and | |
7153 | targets on the same command line, @code{configure} creates all | |
7154 | combinations of the hosts and targets you list.@refill | |
3d3ab540 RP |
7155 | |
7156 | When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run it | |
7157 | in a configured directory. If you made a single configuration, | |
7158 | without subdirectories, run @code{make} in the source directory. | |
b80282d5 | 7159 | If you have @file{Host-@var{host}/Target-@var{target}} subdirectories, |
3d3ab540 RP |
7160 | run @code{make} in those subdirectories. |
7161 | ||
7162 | Each @code{configure} and @code{Makefile} under each source directory | |
3e0d0a27 RP |
7163 | runs recursively, so that typing @code{make} in @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__} (or in a |
7164 | @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__/Host-@var{host}/Target-@var{target}} subdirectory) | |
3d3ab540 RP |
7165 | builds all the required libraries, then _GDBN__.@refill |
7166 | ||
3e0d0a27 | 7167 | If you run @code{configure} from a directory (such as @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__}) that |
3d3ab540 | 7168 | contains source directories for multiple libraries or programs, |
b80282d5 | 7169 | @code{configure} creates the @file{Host-@var{host}/Target-@var{target}} |
3d3ab540 RP |
7170 | subdirectories in each library or program's source directory. For |
7171 | example, typing: | |
7172 | @example | |
3e0d0a27 | 7173 | cd gdb-_GDB_VN__ |
b80282d5 | 7174 | configure sun4 +target=vxworks960 |
3d3ab540 RP |
7175 | @end example |
7176 | @noindent | |
7177 | creates the following directories: | |
b80282d5 | 7178 | @smallexample |
3e0d0a27 RP |
7179 | gdb-_GDB_VN__/Host-sparc-sun-sunos4/Target-i960-wrs-vxworks |
7180 | gdb-_GDB_VN__/bfd/Host-sparc-sun-sunos4/Target-i960-wrs-vxworks | |
7181 | gdb-_GDB_VN__/gdb/Host-sparc-sun-sunos4/Target-i960-wrs-vxworks | |
7182 | gdb-_GDB_VN__/libiberty/Host-sparc-sun-sunos4/Target-i960-wrs-vxworks | |
7183 | gdb-_GDB_VN__/readline/Host-sparc-sun-sunos4/Target-i960-wrs-vxworks | |
b80282d5 RP |
7184 | @end smallexample |
7185 | @noindent | |
7186 | The @code{Makefile} in | |
7187 | @smallexample | |
3e0d0a27 | 7188 | gdb-_GDB_VN__/Host-sparc-sun-sunos4/Target-i960-wrs-vxworks |
b80282d5 | 7189 | @end smallexample |
70b88761 | 7190 | @noindent |
b80282d5 RP |
7191 | will @code{cd} to the appropriate lower-level directories, for example: |
7192 | @smallexample | |
3e0d0a27 | 7193 | gdb-_GDB_VN__/bfd/Host-sparc-sun-sunos4/Target-i960-wrs-vxworks |
b80282d5 RP |
7194 | @end smallexample |
7195 | @noindent | |
7196 | building each in turn. | |
3d3ab540 RP |
7197 | |
7198 | When you have multiple hosts or targets configured, you can run | |
7199 | @code{make} on them in parallel (for example, if they are NFS-mounted on | |
7200 | each of the hosts); they will not interfere with each other. | |
7201 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
7202 | @node Config Names, configure Options, Subdirectories, Installing _GDBN__ |
7203 | @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets | |
7204 | ||
7205 | The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure} | |
7206 | script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined | |
7207 | aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces | |
7208 | of information in the following pattern: | |
7209 | @example | |
7210 | @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os} | |
7211 | @end example | |
7212 | ||
7213 | For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument | |
7214 | or in a @code{+target=}@var{target} option, but the full name of that | |
7215 | configuration specifies that the architecture is @samp{sparc}, the | |
7216 | vendor is @samp{sun}, and the operating system is @samp{sunos4}. | |
7217 | ||
7218 | @iftex | |
7219 | @c I know this is ugly, but @group is useless except in examples now... | |
7220 | @c (using texinfo 2.52 or so) | |
7221 | @page | |
7222 | @end iftex | |
7223 | ||
7224 | The following table shows all the architectures, hosts, and OS prefixes | |
3e0d0a27 | 7225 | that @code{configure} recognizes in _GDBN__ _GDB_VN__. Entries in the ``OS |
b80282d5 RP |
7226 | prefix'' column ending in a @samp{*} may be followed by a release number. |
7227 | ||
7228 | @ifinfo | |
7229 | @example | |
7230 | ||
7231 | ARCHITECTURE VENDOR OS prefix | |
7232 | ------------+-------------+------------- | |
7233 | | | | |
c338a2fd RP |
7234 | 580 | altos | aix* |
7235 | a29k | amdahl | amigados | |
7236 | alliant | aout | aout | |
7237 | arm | apollo | bout | |
7238 | c1 | att | bsd* | |
7239 | c2 | bull | coff | |
7240 | cray2 | bcs | ctix* | |
7241 | h8300 | bout | dynix* | |
7242 | i386 | cbm | esix* | |
7243 | i860 | coff | hpux* | |
7244 | i960 | convergent | irix* | |
7245 | m68000 | convex | isc* | |
7246 | m68k | cray | kern | |
7247 | m88k | dec | mach* | |
7248 | mips | encore | newsos* | |
7249 | ns32k | gould | nindy* | |
7250 | pyramid | hp | none | |
7251 | romp | ibm | osf* | |
7252 | rs6000 | intel | sco* | |
7253 | rtpc | isi | sunos* | |
7254 | sparc | little | svr4 | |
7255 | tahoe | mips | sym* | |
7256 | tron | motorola | sysv* | |
7257 | vax | ncr | ultrix* | |
7258 | xmp | next | unicos | |
7259 | ymp | none | unos* | |
7260 | | nyu | uts | |
7261 | | sco | v88r* | |
7262 | | sequent | vms* | |
7263 | | sgi | vxworks* | |
b80282d5 RP |
7264 | | sony | |
7265 | | sun | | |
7266 | | unicom | | |
7267 | | utek | | |
7268 | | wrs | | |
7269 | ||
7270 | @end example | |
7271 | @end ifinfo | |
c338a2fd RP |
7272 | @c FIXME: this table is probably screwed in @smallbook. Try setting |
7273 | @c FIXME...smallbook fonts? | |
b80282d5 | 7274 | @tex |
c338a2fd RP |
7275 | %\vskip\parskip |
7276 | \vskip \baselineskip | |
7277 | \halign{\hskip\parindent\tt #\hfil &\qquad#&\tt #\hfil &\qquad#&\tt | |
7278 | #\hfil &\qquad\qquad\it #\hfil\cr | |
b80282d5 | 7279 | {\bf Architecture} &&{\bf Vendor} &&{\bf OS prefix}\cr |
c338a2fd | 7280 | \multispan5\hrulefill\cr |
b80282d5 | 7281 | \cr |
c338a2fd RP |
7282 | 580 && altos && aix* \cr |
7283 | a29k && amdahl && amigados\cr | |
7284 | alliant && aout && aout \cr | |
7285 | arm && apollo && bout \cr | |
7286 | c1 && att && bsd* \cr | |
7287 | c2 && bull && coff \cr | |
7288 | cray2 && bcs && ctix* \cr | |
7289 | h8300 && bout && dynix* \cr | |
7290 | i386 && cbm && esix* \cr | |
7291 | i860 && coff && hpux* &Warning: Many combinations \cr | |
7292 | i960 && convergent && irix* &of architecture, vendor \cr | |
7293 | m68000 && convex && isc* &and OS are untested. \cr | |
7294 | m68k && cray && kern \cr | |
7295 | m88k && dec && mach* \cr | |
7296 | mips && encore && newsos* \cr | |
7297 | ns32k && gould && nindy* \cr | |
7298 | pyramid && hp && none \cr | |
7299 | romp && ibm && osf* \cr | |
7300 | rs6000 && intel && sco* \cr | |
7301 | rtpc && isi && sunos* \cr | |
7302 | sparc && little && svr4 \cr | |
7303 | tahoe && mips && sym* \cr | |
7304 | tron && motorola && sysv* \cr | |
7305 | vax && ncr && ultrix* \cr | |
7306 | xmp && next && unicos \cr | |
7307 | ymp && none && unos* \cr | |
7308 | && nyu && uts \cr | |
7309 | && sco && v88r* \cr | |
7310 | && sequent && vms* \cr | |
7311 | && sgi && vxworks*\cr | |
7312 | && sony &&\cr | |
7313 | && sun &&\cr | |
7314 | && unicom &&\cr | |
7315 | && utek &&\cr | |
7316 | && wrs &&\cr | |
b80282d5 RP |
7317 | } |
7318 | @end tex | |
b80282d5 | 7319 | |
3e0d0a27 | 7320 | The @code{configure} script accompanying _GDBN__ _GDB_VN__ does not provide |
b80282d5 RP |
7321 | any query facility to list all supported host and target names or |
7322 | aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script | |
7323 | @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the | |
7324 | script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on | |
7325 | abbreviations---for example: | |
7326 | @example | |
7327 | % sh config.sub sun4 | |
7328 | sparc-sun-sunos4 | |
7329 | % sh config.sub sun3 | |
7330 | m68k-sun-sunos4 | |
7331 | % sh config.sub decstation | |
7332 | mips-dec-ultrix | |
7333 | % sh config.sub hp300bsd | |
7334 | m68k-hp-bsd | |
7335 | % sh config.sub i386v | |
7336 | i386-none-sysv | |
7337 | % sh config.sub i486v | |
7338 | *** No vendor: configuration `i486v' not recognized | |
7339 | @end example | |
7340 | ||
7341 | @node configure Options, Formatting Manual, Config Names, Installing _GDBN__ | |
3d3ab540 | 7342 | @section @code{configure} Options |
7463aadd RP |
7343 | |
7344 | Here is a summary of all the @code{configure} options and arguments that | |
7345 | you might use for building _GDBN__: | |
7346 | ||
7347 | @example | |
b80282d5 RP |
7348 | configure @r{[}+destdir=@var{dir}@r{]} @r{[}+subdirs@r{]} @r{[}+norecur@r{]} @r{[}+rm@r{]} |
7349 | @r{[}+target=@var{target}@dots{}@r{]} @var{host}@dots{} | |
7463aadd | 7350 | @end example |
3d3ab540 | 7351 | @noindent |
7463aadd | 7352 | You may introduce options with the character @samp{-} rather than |
b80282d5 RP |
7353 | @samp{+} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use |
7354 | @samp{+}. | |
70b88761 RP |
7355 | |
7356 | @table @code | |
7463aadd | 7357 | @item +destdir=@var{dir} |
3d3ab540 RP |
7358 | @var{dir} is an installation directory @emph{path prefix}. After you |
7359 | configure with this option, @code{make install} will install _GDBN__ as | |
7360 | @file{@var{dir}/bin/_GDBP__}, and the libraries in @file{@var{dir}/lib}. | |
7361 | If you specify @samp{+destdir=/usr/local}, for example, @code{make | |
7362 | install} creates @file{/usr/local/bin/gdb}.@refill | |
7463aadd | 7363 | |
b80282d5 | 7364 | @item +subdirs |
3d3ab540 | 7365 | Write configuration specific files in subdirectories of the form |
7463aadd | 7366 | @example |
b80282d5 | 7367 | Host-@var{host}/Target-@var{target} |
7463aadd RP |
7368 | @end example |
7369 | @noindent | |
3d3ab540 | 7370 | (and configure the @code{Makefile} to write binaries there too). |
7463aadd RP |
7371 | Without this option, if you specify only one configuration for _GDBN__, |
7372 | @code{configure} will use the same directory for source, configured | |
7373 | files, and binaries. This option is used automatically if you specify | |
b80282d5 | 7374 | more than one @var{host} or more than one @samp{+target=@var{target}} |
7463aadd RP |
7375 | option on the @code{configure} command line. |
7376 | ||
7377 | @item +norecur | |
7378 | Configure only the directory where @code{configure} is executed; do not | |
7379 | propagate configuration to subdirectories. | |
7380 | ||
7381 | @item +rm | |
b80282d5 | 7382 | Remove the configuration that the other arguments specify. |
7463aadd | 7383 | |
c2bbbb22 RP |
7384 | @item +parse=@var{lang} @dots{} |
7385 | Configure the _GDBN__ expression parser to parse the listed languages. | |
7386 | @samp{all} configures _GDBN__ for all supported languages. To get a | |
7387 | list of all supported languages, omit the argument. Without this | |
7388 | option, _GDBN__ is configured to parse all supported languages. | |
7389 | ||
b80282d5 | 7390 | @item +target=@var{target} @dots{} |
3d3ab540 | 7391 | Configure _GDBN__ for cross-debugging programs running on each specified |
b80282d5 RP |
7392 | @var{target}. You may specify as many @samp{+target} options as you |
7393 | wish. Without this option, _GDBN__ is configured to debug programs that | |
7394 | run on the same machine (@var{host}) as _GDBN__ itself. | |
7395 | ||
7396 | There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets. | |
7463aadd RP |
7397 | |
7398 | @item @var{host} @dots{} | |
3d3ab540 | 7399 | Configure _GDBN__ to run on each specified @var{host}. You may specify as |
b80282d5 RP |
7400 | many host names as you wish. |
7401 | ||
7402 | There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts. | |
70b88761 RP |
7403 | @end table |
7404 | ||
3d3ab540 RP |
7405 | @noindent |
7406 | @code{configure} accepts other options, for compatibility with | |
b80282d5 | 7407 | configuring other GNU tools recursively; but these are the only |
3d3ab540 RP |
7408 | options that affect _GDBN__ or its supporting libraries. |
7409 | ||
7410 | @node Formatting Manual, , configure Options, Installing _GDBN__ | |
7411 | @section Formatting this Manual | |
7412 | ||
3e0d0a27 RP |
7413 | The _GDBN__ _GDB_VN__ release includes the Info version of this manual already |
7414 | formatted: the main Info file is @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__/gdb/gdb.info}, and it | |
b80282d5 RP |
7415 | refers to subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same |
7416 | directory. | |
7417 | ||
7418 | If you want to make these Info files yourself from the _GDBN__ manual's | |
7419 | source, you need the GNU @code{makeinfo} program. Once you have it, you | |
7420 | can type | |
3d3ab540 | 7421 | @example |
3e0d0a27 | 7422 | cd gdb-_GDB_VN__/gdb |
3d3ab540 RP |
7423 | make gdb.info |
7424 | @end example | |
7425 | @noindent | |
7426 | to make the Info file. | |
7427 | ||
7428 | If you want to format and print copies of this manual, you need several | |
7429 | things: | |
7430 | @itemize @bullet | |
7431 | @item | |
7432 | @TeX{}, the public domain typesetting program written by Donald Knuth, | |
7433 | must be installed on your system and available through your execution | |
7434 | path. | |
7435 | @item | |
3e0d0a27 | 7436 | @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__/texinfo}: @TeX{} macros defining the GNU |
3d3ab540 RP |
7437 | Documentation Format. |
7438 | @item | |
7439 | @emph{A @sc{dvi} output program.} @TeX{} doesn't actually make marks on | |
7440 | paper; it produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. If your system | |
7441 | has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has a program for printing out | |
7442 | these files; one popular example is @code{dvips}, which can print | |
7443 | @sc{dvi} files on PostScript printers. | |
7444 | @end itemize | |
7445 | @noindent | |
7446 | Once you have these things, you can type | |
7447 | @example | |
3e0d0a27 | 7448 | cd gdb-_GDB_VN__/gdb |
3d3ab540 RP |
7449 | make gdb.dvi |
7450 | @end example | |
7451 | @noindent | |
7452 | to format the text of this manual, and print it with the usual output | |
7453 | method for @TeX{} @sc{dvi} files at your site. | |
7454 | ||
b80282d5 RP |
7455 | @cindex _GDBN__ reference card |
7456 | @cindex reference card | |
7457 | You might also want hard copy of the _GDBN__ reference card. The | |
3e0d0a27 RP |
7458 | _GDBN__ _GDB_VN__ release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready |
7459 | for printing on a PostScript printer, as @file{gdb-_GDB_VN__/gdb/refcard.ps}. | |
b80282d5 RP |
7460 | It uses the most common PostScript fonts: the Times family, Courier, and |
7461 | Symbol. If you have a PostScript printer you can print the reference | |
7462 | card by just sending @file{refcard.ps} to the printer. | |
7463 | ||
7464 | If you have some other kind of printer, or want to print using Computer | |
7465 | Modern fonts instead, you can still print the reference card if you have | |
7466 | @TeX{}. Format the reference card by typing | |
7467 | @example | |
3e0d0a27 | 7468 | cd gdb-_GDB_VN__/gdb |
b80282d5 RP |
7469 | make refcard.dvi |
7470 | @end example | |
7471 | @noindent | |
7472 | ||
7473 | The _GDBN__ reference card is designed to print in landscape mode on US | |
7474 | ``letter'' size paper; that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches | |
7475 | high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to | |
7476 | your @sc{dvi} output program. | |
7477 | ||
7478 | ||
70b88761 | 7479 | @node Copying, Index, Installing _GDBN__, Top |
70b88761 | 7480 | @unnumbered GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE |
7463aadd | 7481 | @center Version 2, June 1991 |
70b88761 RP |
7482 | |
7483 | @display | |
7463aadd | 7484 | Copyright @copyright{} 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
70b88761 RP |
7485 | 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA |
7486 | ||
7487 | Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies | |
7488 | of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. | |
7489 | @end display | |
7490 | ||
7491 | @unnumberedsec Preamble | |
7492 | ||
7463aadd RP |
7493 | The licenses for most software are designed to take away your |
7494 | freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public | |
70b88761 | 7495 | License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free |
7463aadd RP |
7496 | software---to make sure the software is free for all its users. This |
7497 | General Public License applies to most of the Free Software | |
7498 | Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to | |
7499 | using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by | |
7500 | the GNU Library General Public License instead.) You can apply it to | |
7501 | your programs, too. | |
70b88761 RP |
7502 | |
7503 | When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not | |
7463aadd RP |
7504 | price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you |
7505 | have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for | |
7506 | this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it | |
7507 | if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it | |
7508 | in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things. | |
70b88761 RP |
7509 | |
7510 | To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid | |
7511 | anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights. | |
7512 | These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you | |
7513 | distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it. | |
7514 | ||
7463aadd | 7515 | For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether |
70b88761 RP |
7516 | gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that |
7517 | you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the | |
7463aadd RP |
7518 | source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their |
7519 | rights. | |
70b88761 RP |
7520 | |
7521 | We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and | |
7522 | (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy, | |
7523 | distribute and/or modify the software. | |
7524 | ||
7525 | Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain | |
7526 | that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free | |
7527 | software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we | |
7528 | want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so | |
7529 | that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original | |
7530 | authors' reputations. | |
7531 | ||
7463aadd RP |
7532 | Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software |
7533 | patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free | |
7534 | program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the | |
7535 | program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any | |
7536 | patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. | |
7537 | ||
70b88761 RP |
7538 | The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and |
7539 | modification follow. | |
7540 | ||
7541 | @iftex | |
7463aadd | 7542 | @unnumberedsec TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION |
70b88761 RP |
7543 | @end iftex |
7544 | @ifinfo | |
7463aadd | 7545 | @center TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION |
70b88761 RP |
7546 | @end ifinfo |
7547 | ||
7548 | @enumerate | |
7549 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7550 | This License applies to any program or other work which contains |
7551 | a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed | |
7552 | under the terms of this General Public License. The ``Program'', below, | |
7553 | refers to any such program or work, and a ``work based on the Program'' | |
7554 | means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law: | |
7555 | that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it, | |
7556 | either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another | |
7557 | language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in | |
7558 | the term ``modification''.) Each licensee is addressed as ``you''. | |
7559 | ||
7560 | Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not | |
7561 | covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of | |
7562 | running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program | |
7563 | is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the | |
7564 | Program (independent of having been made by running the Program). | |
7565 | Whether that is true depends on what the Program does. | |
70b88761 RP |
7566 | |
7567 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7568 | You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's |
7569 | source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you | |
7570 | conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate | |
7571 | copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the | |
7572 | notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty; | |
7573 | and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License | |
7574 | along with the Program. | |
70b88761 | 7575 | |
7463aadd RP |
7576 | You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and |
7577 | you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee. | |
70b88761 | 7578 | |
70b88761 | 7579 | @item |
7463aadd RP |
7580 | You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion |
7581 | of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and | |
7582 | distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 | |
7583 | above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: | |
70b88761 | 7584 | |
7463aadd | 7585 | @alphaenumerate |
70b88761 | 7586 | @item |
7463aadd RP |
7587 | You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices |
7588 | stating that you changed the files and the date of any change. | |
70b88761 RP |
7589 | |
7590 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7591 | You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in |
7592 | whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any | |
7593 | part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third | |
7594 | parties under the terms of this License. | |
70b88761 RP |
7595 | |
7596 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7597 | If the modified program normally reads commands interactively |
7598 | when run, you must cause it, when started running for such | |
7599 | interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an | |
7600 | announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a | |
7601 | notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide | |
7602 | a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under | |
7603 | these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this | |
7604 | License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but | |
7605 | does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on | |
7606 | the Program is not required to print an announcement.) | |
7607 | @end alphaenumerate | |
7608 | ||
7609 | These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If | |
7610 | identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program, | |
7611 | and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in | |
7612 | themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those | |
7613 | sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you | |
7614 | distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based | |
7615 | on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of | |
7616 | this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the | |
7617 | entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it. | |
7618 | ||
7619 | Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest | |
7620 | your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to | |
7621 | exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or | |
7622 | collective works based on the Program. | |
7623 | ||
7624 | In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program | |
7625 | with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of | |
7626 | a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under | |
7627 | the scope of this License. | |
70b88761 RP |
7628 | |
7629 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7630 | You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it, |
7631 | under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of | |
7632 | Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following: | |
70b88761 | 7633 | |
7463aadd | 7634 | @alphaenumerate |
70b88761 | 7635 | @item |
7463aadd RP |
7636 | Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable |
7637 | source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections | |
7638 | 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or, | |
70b88761 RP |
7639 | |
7640 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7641 | Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three |
7642 | years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your | |
7643 | cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete | |
7644 | machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be | |
7645 | distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium | |
7646 | customarily used for software interchange; or, | |
70b88761 RP |
7647 | |
7648 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7649 | Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer |
7650 | to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is | |
70b88761 | 7651 | allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you |
7463aadd RP |
7652 | received the program in object code or executable form with such |
7653 | an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.) | |
7654 | @end alphaenumerate | |
7655 | ||
7656 | The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for | |
7657 | making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source | |
7658 | code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any | |
7659 | associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to | |
7660 | control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a | |
7661 | special exception, the source code distributed need not include | |
7662 | anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary | |
7663 | form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the | |
7664 | operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component | |
7665 | itself accompanies the executable. | |
7666 | ||
7667 | If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering | |
7668 | access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent | |
7669 | access to copy the source code from the same place counts as | |
7670 | distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not | |
7671 | compelled to copy the source along with the object code. | |
70b88761 RP |
7672 | |
7673 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7674 | You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program |
7675 | except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt | |
7676 | otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is | |
7677 | void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. | |
7678 | However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under | |
7679 | this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such | |
7680 | parties remain in full compliance. | |
70b88761 RP |
7681 | |
7682 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7683 | You are not required to accept this License, since you have not |
7684 | signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or | |
7685 | distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are | |
7686 | prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by | |
7687 | modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the | |
7688 | Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and | |
7689 | all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying | |
7690 | the Program or works based on it. | |
70b88761 RP |
7691 | |
7692 | @item | |
7693 | Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the | |
7463aadd RP |
7694 | Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the |
7695 | original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to | |
7696 | these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further | |
7697 | restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. | |
7698 | You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to | |
7699 | this License. | |
7700 | ||
7701 | @item | |
7702 | If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent | |
7703 | infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), | |
7704 | conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or | |
7705 | otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not | |
7706 | excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot | |
7707 | distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this | |
7708 | License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you | |
7709 | may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent | |
7710 | license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by | |
7711 | all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then | |
7712 | the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to | |
7713 | refrain entirely from distribution of the Program. | |
7714 | ||
7715 | If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under | |
7716 | any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to | |
7717 | apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other | |
7718 | circumstances. | |
7719 | ||
7720 | It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any | |
7721 | patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any | |
7722 | such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the | |
7723 | integrity of the free software distribution system, which is | |
7724 | implemented by public license practices. Many people have made | |
7725 | generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed | |
7726 | through that system in reliance on consistent application of that | |
7727 | system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing | |
7728 | to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot | |
7729 | impose that choice. | |
7730 | ||
7731 | This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to | |
7732 | be a consequence of the rest of this License. | |
7733 | ||
7734 | @item | |
7735 | If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in | |
7736 | certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the | |
7737 | original copyright holder who places the Program under this License | |
7738 | may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding | |
7739 | those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among | |
7740 | countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates | |
7741 | the limitation as if written in the body of this License. | |
70b88761 RP |
7742 | |
7743 | @item | |
7744 | The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions | |
7745 | of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will | |
7746 | be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to | |
7747 | address new problems or concerns. | |
7748 | ||
7749 | Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program | |
7463aadd | 7750 | specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and ``any |
70b88761 RP |
7751 | later version'', you have the option of following the terms and conditions |
7752 | either of that version or of any later version published by the Free | |
7753 | Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of | |
7463aadd | 7754 | this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software |
70b88761 RP |
7755 | Foundation. |
7756 | ||
7757 | @item | |
7758 | If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free | |
7759 | programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author | |
7760 | to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free | |
7761 | Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes | |
7762 | make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals | |
7763 | of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and | |
7764 | of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally. | |
7765 | ||
7766 | @iftex | |
7767 | @heading NO WARRANTY | |
7768 | @end iftex | |
7769 | @ifinfo | |
7770 | @center NO WARRANTY | |
7771 | @end ifinfo | |
7772 | ||
7773 | @item | |
7774 | BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY | |
7775 | FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN | |
7776 | OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES | |
7777 | PROVIDE THE PROGRAM ``AS IS'' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED | |
7778 | OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF | |
7779 | MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS | |
7780 | TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE | |
7781 | PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, | |
7782 | REPAIR OR CORRECTION. | |
7783 | ||
7784 | @item | |
7463aadd RP |
7785 | IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING |
7786 | WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR | |
70b88761 | 7787 | REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, |
7463aadd RP |
7788 | INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING |
7789 | OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED | |
7790 | TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY | |
7791 | YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER | |
7792 | PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE | |
7793 | POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. | |
70b88761 RP |
7794 | @end enumerate |
7795 | ||
7796 | @iftex | |
7797 | @heading END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS | |
7798 | @end iftex | |
7799 | @ifinfo | |
7800 | @center END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS | |
7801 | @end ifinfo | |
7802 | ||
7803 | @page | |
54e6b3c3 | 7804 | @unnumberedsec Applying These Terms to Your New Programs |
70b88761 RP |
7805 | |
7806 | If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest | |
7463aadd RP |
7807 | possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it |
7808 | free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. | |
70b88761 | 7809 | |
7463aadd RP |
7810 | To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest |
7811 | to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively | |
7812 | convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least | |
7813 | the ``copyright'' line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. | |
70b88761 RP |
7814 | |
7815 | @smallexample | |
7816 | @var{one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.} | |
7817 | Copyright (C) 19@var{yy} @var{name of author} | |
7818 | ||
7819 | This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | |
7820 | it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | |
7463aadd RP |
7821 | the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or |
7822 | (at your option) any later version. | |
70b88761 RP |
7823 | |
7824 | This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | |
7825 | but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | |
7826 | MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the | |
7827 | GNU General Public License for more details. | |
7828 | ||
7829 | You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
7830 | along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software | |
7831 | Foundation, Inc., 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA. | |
7832 | @end smallexample | |
7833 | ||
7834 | Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. | |
7835 | ||
7836 | If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this | |
7837 | when it starts in an interactive mode: | |
7838 | ||
7839 | @smallexample | |
7840 | Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) 19@var{yy} @var{name of author} | |
7841 | Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'. | |
7842 | This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it | |
7843 | under certain conditions; type `show c' for details. | |
7844 | @end smallexample | |
7845 | ||
7463aadd RP |
7846 | The hypothetical commands @samp{show w} and @samp{show c} should show |
7847 | the appropriate parts of the General Public License. Of course, the | |
7848 | commands you use may be called something other than @samp{show w} and | |
7849 | @samp{show c}; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu items---whatever | |
7850 | suits your program. | |
70b88761 RP |
7851 | |
7852 | You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your | |
7853 | school, if any, to sign a ``copyright disclaimer'' for the program, if | |
7854 | necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names: | |
7855 | ||
7463aadd RP |
7856 | @example |
7857 | Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program | |
7858 | `Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker. | |
70b88761 RP |
7859 | |
7860 | @var{signature of Ty Coon}, 1 April 1989 | |
7861 | Ty Coon, President of Vice | |
7463aadd RP |
7862 | @end example |
7863 | ||
7864 | This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into | |
7865 | proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may | |
7866 | consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the | |
7867 | library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Library General | |
7868 | Public License instead of this License. | |
70b88761 | 7869 | |
d2e08421 | 7870 | |
9c3ad547 | 7871 | @node Index, , Copying, Top |
d2e08421 | 7872 | @unnumbered Index |
e91b87a3 | 7873 | |
7874 | @printindex cp | |
7875 | ||
fe3f5fc8 RP |
7876 | @tex |
7877 | % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the | |
7878 | % meantime: | |
7879 | \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill | |
7880 | \centerline{The body of this manual is set in} | |
7881 | \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,} | |
7882 | \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}} | |
7883 | \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.} | |
7884 | \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and} | |
7885 | \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}} | |
7886 | \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill} | |
7887 | \page\colophon | |
7888 | % Blame: [email protected], 28mar91. | |
7889 | @end tex | |
7890 | ||
e91b87a3 | 7891 | @contents |
7892 | @bye |